Difference between revisions of "Module:Citation/CS1"

From Timelines
Jump to: navigation, search
(fix)
(Synch from sandbox;)
 
(104 intermediate revisions by 8 users not shown)
Line 1: Line 1:
---------------------------------------------------------------------
 
-- Module:Citation/CS1 - Lua module for Citation Style 1 templates
 
---------------------------------------------------------------------
 
--                              (see NOTES at bottom)
 
--require "mw.text"
 
  
local z = {
+
local cs1 ={};
    wikitext = require("Module:Wikitext"),
 
    mw = require("Module:Mw")
 
}
 
  
function hideinprint(content)
+
--[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D  D E C L A R A T I O N S >--------------------------------------
    return content
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local dates, year_date_check, reformat_dates, date_hyphen_to_dash -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
 +
 
 +
local is_set, in_array, substitute, error_comment, set_error, select_one, -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 +
add_maint_cat, wrap_style, safe_for_italics, remove_wiki_link;
 +
 
 +
local z ={}; -- tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 +
 
 +
local extract_ids, extract_id_access_levels, build_id_list, is_embargoed; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers
 +
 
 +
local make_coins_title, get_coins_pages, COinS; -- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
 +
 
 +
local cfg = {}; -- table of configuration tables that are defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration
 +
local whitelist = {}; -- table of tables listing valid template parameter names; defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< P A G E  S C O P E  V A R I A B L E S >--------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
delare variables here that have page-wide scope that are not brought in from other modules; thatare created here
 +
and used here
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local added_deprecated_cat; -- boolean flag so that the category is added only once
 +
local added_prop_cats = {}; -- list of property categories that have been added to z.properties_cats
 +
local added_vanc_errs; -- boolean flag so we only emit one Vancouver error / category
 +
 
 +
local Frame; -- holds the module's frame table
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< F I R S T _ S E T >------------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Locates and returns the first set value in a table of values where the order established in the table,
 +
left-to-right (or top-to-bottom), is the order in which the values are evaluated.  Returns nil if none are set.
 +
 
 +
This version replaces the original 'for _, val in pairs do' and a similar version that used ipairs.  With the pairs
 +
version the order of evaluation could not be guaranteed.  With the ipairs version, a nil value would terminate
 +
the for-loop before it reached the actual end of the list.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function first_set (list, count)
 +
local i = 1;
 +
while i <= count do -- loop through all items in list
 +
if is_set( list[i] ) then
 +
return list[i]; -- return the first set list member
 +
end
 +
i = i + 1; -- point to next
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function onlyinprint(content)
+
--[[--------------------------< A D D _ P R O P _ C A T >--------------------------------------------------------
    return ""
+
 
 +
Adds a category to z.properties_cats using names from the configuration file with additional text if any.
 +
 
 +
added_prop_cats is a table declared in page scope variables above
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function add_prop_cat (key, arguments)
 +
if not added_prop_cats [key] then
 +
added_prop_cats [key] = true; -- note that we've added this category
 +
table.insert( z.properties_cats, substitute (cfg.prop_cats [key], arguments)); -- make name then add to table
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function nowiki(frame, content)
+
--[[--------------------------< A D D _ V A N C _ E R R O R >----------------------------------------------------
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="nowiki",contents=content,params={}}, frame)
+
 
 +
Adds a single Vancouver system error message to the template's output regardless of how many error actually exist.
 +
To prevent duplication, added_vanc_errs is nil until an error message is emitted.
 +
 
 +
added_vanc_errs is a boolean declared in page scope variables above
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function add_vanc_error (source)
 +
if not added_vanc_errs then
 +
added_vanc_errs = true; -- note that we've added this category
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'vancouver', {source}, true ) } );
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function externallinkid(frame, args)
+
 
    local sep = args.separator or "&nbsp;"
+
--[[--------------------------< I S _ S C H E M E >------------------------------------------------------------
    args.suffix = args.suffix or ""
+
 
    local url_string = args.id
+
does this thing that purports to be a uri scheme seem to be a valid scheme?  The scheme is checked to see if it
    if args.encode == true or args.encode == nil then
+
is in agreement with http://tools.ietf.org/html/std66#section-3.1 which says:
        url_string = mw.uri.encode( url_string );
+
Scheme names consist of a sequence of characters beginning with a
    end
+
  letter and followed by any combination of letters, digits, plus
   
+
  ("+"), period ("."), or hyphen ("-").
    local t0 = onlyinprint(args.label .. sep .. args.id)
+
 
    local t1 = hideinprint("[[" .. args.link .. "|" .. args.label .. "]]" .. sep .. "[" .. args.prefix .. url_string .. args.suffix .. " " .. nowiki(frame, args.id) .. "]")
+
returns true if it does, else false
   
+
 
    return t0 .. t1
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local function is_scheme (scheme)
 +
return scheme and scheme:match ('^%a[%a%d%+%.%-]*:'); -- true if scheme is set and matches the pattern
 
end
 
end
  
function internallinkid(frame, args)
+
 
    local sep = args.separator or "&nbsp;"
+
--[=[-------------------------< I S _ D O M A I N _ N A M E >--------------------------------------------------
    args.suffix = args.suffix or ""
+
 
    local t0 = onlyinprint(args.label .. sep .. args.id)
+
Does this thing that purports to be a domain name seem to be a valid domain name?
    local t1 = hideinprint("[[" .. args.link .. "|" .. args.label .. "]]" .. sep .. "[[" .. args.prefix .. args.id .. args.suffix .. "|" .. nowiki(frame, args.id) .. "]]")
+
 
    return t0 .. t1
+
Syntax defined here: http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc1034#section-3.5
 +
BNF defined here: https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4234
 +
Single character names are generally reserved; see https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-dnsind-iana-dns-01#page-15;
 +
see also [[Single-letter second-level domain]]
 +
list of tlds: https://www.iana.org/domains/root/db
 +
 
 +
rfc952 (modified by rfc 1123) requires the first and last character of a hostname to be a letter or a digit.  Between
 +
the first and last characters the name may use letters, digits, and the hyphen.
 +
 
 +
Also allowed are IPv4 addresses. IPv6 not supported
 +
 
 +
domain is expected to be stripped of any path so that the last character in the last character of the tld. tld
 +
is two or more alpha characters.  Any preceding '//' (from splitting a url with a scheme) will be stripped
 +
here. Perhaps not necessary but retained incase it is necessary for IPv4 dot decimal.
 +
 
 +
There are several tests:
 +
the first character of the whole domain name including subdomains must be a letter or a digit
 +
internationalized domain name (ascii characters with .xn-- ASCII Compatible Encoding (ACE) prefix xn-- in the tld) see https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3490
 +
single-letter/digit second-level domains in the .org TLD
 +
q, x, and z SL domains in the .com TLD
 +
i and q SL domains in the .net TLD
 +
single-letter SL domains in the ccTLDs (where the ccTLD is two letters)
 +
two-character SL domains in gTLDs (where the gTLD is two or more letters)
 +
three-plus-character SL domains in gTLDs (where the gTLD is two or more letters)
 +
IPv4 dot-decimal address format; TLD not allowed
 +
 
 +
returns true if domain appears to be a proper name and tld or IPv4 address, else false
 +
 
 +
]=]
 +
 
 +
local function is_domain_name (domain)
 +
if not domain then
 +
return false; -- if not set, abandon
 +
end
 +
 +
domain = domain:gsub ('^//', ''); -- strip '//' from domain name if present; done here so we only have to do it once
 +
 +
if not domain:match ('^[%a%d]') then -- first character must be letter or digit
 +
return false;
 +
end
 +
-- Do most common case first
 +
if domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then -- three or more character hostname.hostname or hostname.tld
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.xn%-%-[%a%d]+$') then -- internationalized domain name with ACE prefix
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.org$') then -- one character .org hostname
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][qxz]%.com$') then -- assigned one character .com hostname (x.com times out 2015-12-10)
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][iq]%.net$') then -- assigned one character .net hostname (q.net registered but not active 2015-12-10)
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a$') then -- one character hostname and cctld (2 chars)
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then -- two character hostname and tld
 +
return true;
 +
elseif domain:match ('^%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?') then -- IPv4 address
 +
return true;
 +
else
 +
return false;
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function amazon(frame, id, domain)
+
 
    if ( nil == domain ) then  
+
--[[--------------------------< I S _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------------
        domain = "com"
+
 
    elseif ( "jp" == domain or "uk" == domain ) then
+
returns true if the scheme and domain parts of a url appear to be a valid url; else false.
        domain = "co." .. domain
+
 
    end
+
This function is the last step in the validation process.  This function is separate because there are cases that
    return externallinkid(frame, {link="Amazon Standard Identification Number",label="ASIN",prefix="//www.amazon."..domain.."/dp/",id=id,encode=false})
+
are not covered by split_url(), for example is_parameter_ext_wikilink() which is looking for bracketted external
 +
wikilinks.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function is_url (scheme, domain)
 +
if is_set (scheme) then -- if scheme is set check it and domain
 +
return is_scheme (scheme) and is_domain_name (domain);
 +
else
 +
return is_domain_name (domain); -- scheme not set when url is protocol relative
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function doi(frame, id, inactive, nocat)
 
    local cat = ""
 
    local text;
 
    if ( inactive ~= nil ) then
 
        text = "[[Digital object identifier|doi]]:" .. id;
 
        cat = cat .. "[[Category:Pages with DOIs inactive since " .. selectyear(inactive) .. "]]"
 
        inactive = " (inactive " .. inactive .. ")"
 
    else
 
        text = externallinkid(frame, {link="Digital object identifier",label="doi",prefix="http://dx.doi.org/",id=id,separator=":"})
 
        inactive = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( string.sub(id,1,3) ~= "10." ) then
 
        cat = cat .. "[[Category:Pages with DOI errors]]" .. '<span class="error"> Bad DOI (expected "10." prefix) in code number</span>'
 
    end
 
    if ( nocat and nocat ~= "" ) then cat = "" end
 
    return text .. inactive .. cat   
 
end
 
  
function url(frame, id)
+
--[[--------------------------< S P L I T _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------
    local t0 = onlyinprint(id)
+
 
    local t1 = hideinprint("[" .. id .. " " .. nowiki(frame, id) .. "]")
+
Split a url into a scheme, authority indicator, and domain.
    return t0 .. t1
+
 
 +
First remove Fully Qualified Domain Name terminator (a dot following tld) (if any) and any path(/), query(?) or fragment(#).
 +
 
 +
If protocol relative url, return nil scheme and domain else return nil for both scheme and domain.
 +
 
 +
When not protocol relative, get scheme, authority indicator, and domain.  If there is an authority indicator (one
 +
or more '/' characters immediately following the scheme's colon), make sure that there are only 2.
 +
 
 +
Strip off any port and path;
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function split_url (url_str)
 +
local scheme, authority, domain;
 +
 +
url_str = url_str:gsub ('([%a%d])%.?[/%?#].*$', '%1'); -- strip FQDN terminator and path(/), query(?), fragment (#) (the capture prevents false replacement of '//')
 +
 
 +
if url_str:match ('^//%S*') then -- if there is what appears to be a protocol relative url
 +
domain = url_str:match ('^//(%S*)')
 +
elseif url_str:match ('%S-:/*%S+') then -- if there is what appears to be a scheme, optional authority indicator, and domain name
 +
scheme, authority, domain = url_str:match ('(%S-:)(/*)(%S+)'); -- extract the scheme, authority indicator, and domain portions
 +
authority = authority:gsub ('//', '', 1); -- replace place 1 pair of '/' with nothing;
 +
if is_set(authority) then -- if anything left (1 or 3+ '/' where authority should be) then
 +
return scheme; -- return scheme only making domain nil which will cause an error message
 +
end
 +
domain = domain:gsub ('(%a):%d+', '%1'); -- strip port number if present
 +
end
 +
 +
return scheme, domain;
 
end
 
end
  
function safeforurl( str )
+
 
    return str:gsub( '[%[%]\n]', {   
+
--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ P A R A M _ O K >---------------------------------------------------
        ['['] = '&#91;',
+
 
        [']'] = '&#93;',
+
checks the content of |title-link=, |series-link=, |author-link= etc for properly formatted content: no wikilinks, no urls
        ['\n'] = ' ' } );
+
 
 +
Link parameters are to hold the title of a wikipedia article so none of the WP:TITLESPECIALCHARACTERS are allowed:
 +
# < > [ ] | { } _
 +
except the underscore which is used as a space in wiki urls and # which is used for section links
 +
 
 +
returns false when the value contains any of these characters.
 +
 
 +
When there are no illegal characters, this function returns TRUE if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url (the
 +
|<param>-link= parameter is ok); else false when value appears to be a valid url (the |<param>-link= parameter is NOT ok).
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function link_param_ok (value)
 +
local scheme, domain;
 +
if value:find ('[<>%[%]|{}]') then -- if any prohibited characters
 +
return false;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (value); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url;  
 +
return not is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url
 
end
 
end
  
function hyphentodash( str )
+
--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ T I T L E _ O K >---------------------------------------------------
    return str:gsub( '-', '' );
+
 
 +
Use link_param_ok() to validate |<param>-link= value and its matching |<title>= value.
 +
 
 +
|<title>= may be wikilinked but not when |<param>-link= has a value.  This function emits an error message when
 +
that condition exists
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function link_title_ok (link, lorig, title, torig)
 +
local orig;
 +
 
 +
if is_set (link) then -- don't bother if <param>-link doesn't have a value
 +
if not link_param_ok (link) then -- check |<param>-link= markup
 +
orig = lorig; -- identify the failing link parameter
 +
elseif title:find ('%[%[') then -- check |title= for wikilink markup
 +
orig = torig; -- identify the failing |title= parameter
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (orig) then
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_paramlink', orig)}); -- url or wikilink in |title= with |title-link=;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< C H E C K _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Determines whether a URL string appears to be valid.
 +
 
 +
First we test for space characters.  If any are found, return false.  Then split the url into scheme and domain
 +
portions, or for protocol relative (//example.com) urls, just the domain.  Use is_url() to validate the two
 +
portions of the url.  If both are valid, or for protocol relative if domain is valid, return true, else false.
 +
 
 +
Because it is different from a standard url, and because this module used external_link() to make external links
 +
that work for standard and news: links, we validate newsgroup names here.  The specification for a newsgroup name
 +
is at https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5536#section-3.1.4
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function check_url( url_str )
 +
if nil == url_str:match ("^%S+$") then -- if there are any spaces in |url=value it can't be a proper url
 +
return false;
 +
end
 +
local scheme, domain;
 +
 
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (url_str); -- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url;
 +
 +
if 'news:' == scheme then -- special case for newsgroups
 +
return domain:match('^[%a%d%+%-_]+%.[%a%d%+%-_%.]*[%a%d%+%-_]$');
 +
end
 +
 +
return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid url
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P A R A M E T E R _ E X T _ W I K I L I N K >----------------------------
 +
 
 +
Return true if a parameter value has a string that begins and ends with square brackets [ and ] and the first
 +
non-space characters following the opening bracket appear to be a url.  The test will also find external wikilinks
 +
that use protocol relative urls. Also finds bare urls.
 +
 
 +
The frontier pattern prevents a match on interwiki links which are similar to scheme:path urls.  The tests that
 +
find bracketed urls are required because the parameters that call this test (currently |title=, |chapter=, |work=,
 +
and |publisher=) may have wikilinks and there are articles or redirects like '//Hus' so, while uncommon, |title=[[//Hus]]
 +
is possible as might be [[en://Hus]].
 +
 
 +
]=]
 +
 
 +
local function is_parameter_ext_wikilink (value)
 +
local scheme, domain;
 +
 
 +
if value:match ('%f[%[]%[%a%S*:%S+.*%]') then -- if ext wikilink with scheme and domain: [xxxx://yyyyy.zzz]
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(%a%S*:%S+).*%]'));
 +
elseif value:match ('%f[%[]%[//%S+.*%]') then -- if protocol relative ext wikilink: [//yyyyy.zzz]
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(//%S+).*%]'));
 +
elseif value:match ('%a%S*:%S+') then -- if bare url with scheme; may have leading or trailing plain text
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(%a%S*:%S+)'));
 +
elseif value:match ('//%S+') then -- if protocol relative bare url: //yyyyy.zzz; may have leading or trailing plain text
 +
scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(//%S+)')); -- what is left should be the domain
 +
else
 +
return false; -- didn't find anything that is obviously a url
 +
end
 +
 
 +
return is_url (scheme, domain); -- return true if value appears to be a valid url
 
end
 
end
  
function safeforitalics( str )
+
 
    --[[ Note: We can not use <i> for italics, as the expected behavior for
+
--[[-------------------------< C H E C K _ F O R _ U R L >-----------------------------------------------------
    italics specified by ''...'' in the title is that they will be inverted
+
 
    (i.e. unitalicized) in the resulting references. In addition, <i> and ''
+
loop through a list of parameters and their values. Look at the value and if it has an external link, emit an error message.
    tend to interact poorly under Mediawiki's HTML tidy. ]]
+
 
   
+
]]
    if str == nil or str == '' then
+
 
        return str;
+
local function check_for_url (parameter_list)
    else
+
local error_message = '';
        if str:sub(1,1) == "'" then str = "<span />" .. str; end
+
for k, v in pairs (parameter_list) do -- for each parameter in the list
        if str:sub(-1,-1) == "'" then str = str .. "<span />"; end
+
if is_parameter_ext_wikilink (v) then -- look at the value; if there is a url add an error message
        return str;
+
if is_set(error_message) then -- once we've added the first portion of the error message ...
    end
+
error_message=error_message .. ", "; -- ... add a comma space separator
 +
end
 +
error_message=error_message .. "&#124;" .. k .. "="; -- add the failed parameter
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set (error_message) then -- done looping, if there is an error message, display it
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_has_ext_link', {error_message}, true ) } );
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function safejoin( tbl, duplicate_char )
 
    --[[
 
    Note: we use string functions here, rather than ustring functions.
 
   
 
    This has considerably faster performance and should work correctly as
 
    long as the duplicate_char is strict ASCII.  The strings
 
    in tbl may be ASCII or UTF8.
 
    ]]
 
   
 
    local str = '';
 
    local comp = '';
 
    local end_chr = '';
 
    for _, value in ipairs( tbl ) do
 
        if value == nil then value = ''; end
 
       
 
        if str == '' then
 
            str = value;
 
        elseif value ~= '' then
 
            if value:sub(1,1) == '<' then
 
                -- Special case of values enclosed in spans and other markup.
 
                comp = value:gsub( "%b<>", "" );
 
            else
 
                comp = value;
 
            end
 
           
 
            if comp:sub(1,1) == duplicate_char then
 
                end_chr = str:sub(-1,-1);
 
                if end_chr == duplicate_char then
 
                    str = str:sub(1,-2) .. value;
 
                elseif end_chr == "'" then
 
                    if str:sub(-3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "''" then                 
 
                        str = str:sub(1, -4) .. "''" .. value;
 
                    else
 
                        str = str .. value;
 
                    end
 
                elseif end_chr == " " then
 
                    if str:sub(-2,-1) == duplicate_char .. " " then
 
                        str = str:sub(1,-3) .. value;
 
                    else
 
                        str = str .. value;
 
                    end                       
 
                else
 
                    str = str .. value;
 
                end
 
            else
 
                str = str .. value;
 
            end
 
        end
 
    end
 
    return str;
 
end 
 
  
function selectyear( str )
+
--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ F O R _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------
    local lang = mw.getContentLanguage();
+
 
    local good, result;
+
Escape sequences for content that will be used for URL descriptions
    good, result = pcall( lang.formatDate, lang, 'Y', str )
+
 
    if good then  
+
]]
        return result;
+
 
    else
+
local function safe_for_url( str )
        return '';
+
if str:match( "%[%[.-%]%]" ) ~= nil then
    end
+
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'wikilink_in_url', {}, true ) } );
 +
end
 +
 +
return str:gsub( '[%[%]\n]', {
 +
['['] = '&#91;',
 +
[']'] = '&#93;',
 +
['\n'] = ' ' } );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< E X T E R N A L _ L I N K >----------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Format an external link with error checking
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function external_link( URL, label, source, access)
 +
local error_str = "";
 +
local domain;
 +
local path;
 +
local base_url;
 +
 +
if not is_set( label ) then
 +
label = URL;
 +
if is_set( source ) then
 +
error_str = set_error( 'bare_url_missing_title', { wrap_style ('parameter', source) }, false, " " );
 +
else
 +
error( cfg.messages["bare_url_no_origin"] );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if not check_url( URL ) then
 +
error_str = set_error( 'bad_url', {wrap_style ('parameter', source)}, false, " " ) .. error_str;
 +
end
 +
 +
domain, path = URL:match ('^([/%.%-%+:%a%d]+)([/%?#].*)$'); -- split the url into scheme plus domain and path
 +
if path then -- if there is a path portion
 +
path = path:gsub ('[%[%]]', {['[']='%5b',[']']='%5d'}); -- replace '[' and ']' with their percent encoded values
 +
URL=domain..path; -- and reassemble
 +
end
 +
 +
base_url = table.concat({ "[", URL, " ", safe_for_url( label ), "]" });
 +
 +
if is_set(access) then -- access level (free, paywalled, ...)
 +
base_url = substitute(cfg.presentation[access], base_url);
 +
end
 +
 +
return table.concat({ base_url, error_str });
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< D E P R E C A T E D _ P A R A M E T E R >--------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Categorize and emit an error message when the citation contains one or more deprecated parameters.  The function includes the
 +
offending parameter name to the error message.  Only one error message is emitted regardless of the number of deprecated
 +
parameters in the citation.
 +
 
 +
added_deprecated_cat is a boolean declared in page scope variables above
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function deprecated_parameter(name)
 +
if not added_deprecated_cat then
 +
added_deprecated_cat = true; -- note that we've added this category
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'deprecated_params', {name}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< K E R N _ Q U O T E S >--------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Apply kerning to open the space between the quote mark provided by the Module and a leading or trailing quote mark contained in a |title= or |chapter= parameter's value.
 +
This function will positive kern either single or double quotes:
 +
"'Unkerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks'"
 +
" 'Kerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks' " (in real life the kerning isn't as wide as this example)
 +
Double single quotes (italic or bold wikimarkup) are not kerned.
 +
 
 +
Replaces unicode quotemarks with typewriter quote marks regardless of the need for kerning.
 +
 
 +
Call this function for chapter titles, for website titles, etc; not for book titles.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function kern_quotes (str)
 +
local cap='';
 +
local cap2='';
 +
-- TODO: move this elswhere so that all title-holding elements get these quote marks replaced?
 +
str= mw.ustring.gsub (str, '[“”]', '\"'); -- replace “” (U+201C & U+201D) with " (typewriter double quote mark)
 +
str= mw.ustring.gsub (str, '[‘’]', '\''); -- replace ‘’ (U+2018 & U+2019) with ' (typewriter single quote mark)
 +
 +
cap, cap2 = str:match ("^([\"\'])([^\'].+)"); -- match leading double or single quote but not double single quotes
 +
if is_set (cap) then
 +
str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], {cap, cap2});
 +
end
 +
 
 +
cap, cap2 = str:match ("^(.+[^\'])([\"\'])$")
 +
if is_set (cap) then
 +
str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], {cap, cap2});
 +
end
 +
return str;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ S C R I P T _ V A L U E >----------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
|script-title= holds title parameters that are not written in Latin based scripts: Chinese, Japanese, Arabic, Hebrew, etc. These scripts should
 +
not be italicized and may be written right-to-left.  The value supplied by |script-title= is concatenated onto Title after Title has been wrapped
 +
in italic markup.
 +
 
 +
Regardless of language, all values provided by |script-title= are wrapped in <bdi>...</bdi> tags to isolate rtl languages from the English left to right.
 +
 
 +
|script-title= provides a unique feature.  The value in |script-title= may be prefixed with a two-character ISO639-1 language code and a colon:
 +
|script-title=ja:*** *** (where * represents a Japanese character)
 +
Spaces between the two-character code and the colon and the colon and the first script character are allowed:
 +
|script-title=ja : *** ***
 +
|script-title=ja: *** ***
 +
|script-title=ja :*** ***
 +
Spaces preceding the prefix are allowed: |script-title = ja:*** ***
 +
 
 +
The prefix is checked for validity.  If it is a valid ISO639-1 language code, the lang attribute (lang="ja") is added to the <bdi> tag so that browsers can
 +
know the language the tag contains. This may help the browser render the script more correctly.  If the prefix is invalid, the lang attribute
 +
is not added.  At this time there is no error message for this condition.
 +
 
 +
Supports |script-title= and |script-chapter=
 +
 
 +
TODO: error messages when prefix is invalid ISO639-1 code; when script_value has prefix but no script;
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function format_script_value (script_value)
 +
local lang=''; -- initialize to empty string
 +
local name;
 +
if script_value:match('^%l%l%s*:') then -- if first 3 non-space characters are script language prefix
 +
lang = script_value:match('^(%l%l)%s*:%s*%S.*'); -- get the language prefix or nil if there is no script
 +
if not is_set (lang) then
 +
return ''; -- script_value was just the prefix so return empty string
 +
end
 +
-- if we get this far we have prefix and script
 +
name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang, "en" ); -- get language name so that we can use it to categorize
 +
if is_set (name) then -- is prefix a proper ISO 639-1 language code?
 +
script_value = script_value:gsub ('^%l%l%s*:%s*', ''); -- strip prefix from script
 +
-- is prefix one of these language codes?
 +
if in_array (lang, cfg.script_lang_codes) then
 +
add_prop_cat ('script_with_name', {name, lang})
 +
else
 +
add_prop_cat ('script')
 +
end
 +
lang = ' lang="' .. lang .. '" '; -- convert prefix into a lang attribute
 +
else
 +
lang = ''; -- invalid so set lang to empty string
 +
end
 +
end
 +
script_value = substitute (cfg.presentation['bdi'], {lang, script_value}); -- isolate in case script is rtl
 +
 
 +
return script_value;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< S C R I P T _ C O N C A T E N A T E >------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Initially for |title= and |script-title=, this function concatenates those two parameter values after the script value has been
 +
wrapped in <bdi> tags.
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function script_concatenate (title, script)
 +
if is_set (script) then
 +
script = format_script_value (script); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; returns empty string on error
 +
if is_set (script) then
 +
title = title .. ' ' .. script; -- concatenate title and script title
 +
end
 +
end
 +
return title;
 
end
 
end
  
function openlibrary(frame, id)
+
 
    local cat = ""
+
--[[--------------------------< W R A P _ M S G >--------------------------------------------------------------
    local prefix = ""
+
 
    local code = id:sub(-1,-1)
+
Applies additional message text to various parameter values. Supplied string is wrapped using a message_list
    if ( code == "A" ) then
+
configuration taking one argument.  Supports lower case text for {{citation}} templates.  Additional text taken
        prefix = "http://openlibrary.org/authors/OL"
+
from citation_config.messages - the reason this function is similar to but separate from wrap_style().
    elseif ( code == "M" ) then
+
 
        prefix = "http://openlibrary.org/books/OL"
+
]]
    elseif ( code == "W" ) then
+
 
        prefix = "http://openlibrary.org/works/OL"
+
local function wrap_msg (key, str, lower)
    else
+
if not is_set( str ) then
        prefix = "http://openlibrary.org/OL"
+
return "";
        cat = cat .. "[[Category:Pages with OL errors]]"
+
end
    end
+
if true == lower then
    local text = externallinkid(frame, {link="Open Library",label="OL",prefix=prefix,id=id})
+
local msg;
    return text .. cat
+
msg = cfg.messages[key]:lower(); -- set the message to lower case before
 +
return substitute( msg, str ); -- including template text
 +
else
 +
return substitute( cfg.messages[key], str );
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function reducetoinitials(first)
+
 
    local initials = {}
+
--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ C H A P T E R _ T I T L E >--------------------------------------
    for word in string.gmatch(first, "%S+") do
+
 
        table.insert(initials, string.sub(word,1,1)) -- Vancouver format does not include full stops.
+
Format the four chapter parameters: |script-chapter=, |chapter=, |trans-chapter=, and |chapter-url= into a single Chapter meta-
    end
+
parameter (chapter_url_source used for error messages).
    return table.concat(initials) -- Vancouver format does not include spaces.
+
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function format_chapter_title (scriptchapter, chapter, transchapter, chapterurl, chapter_url_source, no_quotes)
 +
local chapter_error = '';
 +
 +
if not is_set (chapter) then
 +
chapter = ''; -- to be safe for concatenation
 +
else
 +
if false == no_quotes then
 +
chapter = kern_quotes (chapter); -- if necessary, separate chapter title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
 +
chapter = wrap_style ('quoted-title', chapter);
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
chapter = script_concatenate (chapter, scriptchapter) -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
 +
 
 +
if is_set (transchapter) then
 +
transchapter = wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', transchapter);
 +
if is_set (chapter) then
 +
chapter = chapter ..  ' ' .. transchapter;
 +
else -- here when transchapter without chapter or script-chapter
 +
chapter = transchapter; --
 +
chapter_error = ' ' .. set_error ('trans_missing_title', {'chapter'});
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (chapterurl) then
 +
chapter = external_link (chapterurl, chapter, chapter_url_source, nil); -- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate
 +
end
 +
 
 +
return chapter .. chapter_error;
 
end
 
end
  
function listpeople(control, people)
+
--[[--------------------------< H A S _ I N V I S I B L E _ C H A R S >----------------------------------------
    local sep = control.sep;
+
 
    if sep:sub(-1,-1) ~= " " then sep = sep .. " " end
+
This function searches a parameter's value for nonprintable or invisible characters.  The search stops at the
    local namesep = control.namesep
+
first match.
    local format = control.format
+
 
    local maximum = control.maximum
+
This function will detect the visible replacement character when it is part of the wikisource.
    local text = {}
+
 
    local etal = false;
+
Detects but ignores nowiki and math stripmarkers.  Also detects other named stripmarkers (gallery, math, pre, ref)
    for i,person in ipairs(people) do
+
and identifies them with a slightly different error message. See also coins_cleanup().
        if (person.last ~= nil or person.last ~= "") then
+
 
            local mask = person.mask
+
Detects but ignores the character pattern that results from the transclusion of {{'}} templates.
            local one
+
 
            if ( maximum ~= nil and i == maximum + 1 ) then
+
Output of this function is an error message that identifies the character or the Unicode group, or the stripmarker
                etal = true;
+
that was detected along with its position (or, for multi-byte characters, the position of its first byte) in the
                break;
+
parameter value.
            elseif (mask ~= nil) then
+
 
                local n = tonumber(mask)
+
]]
                if (n ~= nil) then
+
 
                    one = string.rep("&mdash;",n)
+
local function has_invisible_chars (param, v)
                else
+
local position = ''; -- position of invisible char or starting position of stripmarker
                    one = mask
+
local dummy; -- end of matching string; not used but required to hold end position when a capture is returned
                end
+
local capture; -- used by stripmarker detection to hold name of the stripmarker
            else
+
local i=1;
                one = person.last
+
local stripmarker, apostrophe;
                local first = person.first
+
                if (first ~= nil) then  
+
capture = string.match (v, '[%w%p ]*'); -- Test for values that are simple ASCII text and bypass other tests if true
                    if ( "vanc" == format ) then first = reducetoinitials(first) end
+
if capture == v then -- if same there are no unicode characters
                    one = one .. namesep .. first
+
return;
                end
+
end
                if (person.link ~= nil and person.link ~= "") then one = "[[" .. person.link .. "|" .. one .. "]]" end
+
 
            end
+
while cfg.invisible_chars[i] do
            table.insert(text, one)
+
local char=cfg.invisible_chars[i][1] -- the character or group name
        end
+
local pattern=cfg.invisible_chars[i][2] -- the pattern used to find it
    end
+
position, dummy, capture = mw.ustring.find (v, pattern) -- see if the parameter value contains characters that match the pattern
    local count = #text;
+
    local result = table.concat(text, sep) -- construct list
+
if position then
    if etal then  
+
if 'nowiki' == capture or 'math' == capture then -- nowiki, math stripmarker (not an error condition)
        local etal_text = "et al."
+
stripmarker = true; -- set a flag
        if (sepc == ".") then etal_text = "et al" end
+
elseif true == stripmarker and 'delete' == char then -- because stripmakers begin and end with the delete char, assume that we've found one end of a stripmarker
        result = result .. " " .. etal_text;
+
position = nil; -- unset
    end
+
else
   
+
local err_msg;
    if ( "scap" == format ) then result= z.mw.text.tag({name="span", contents=result, params={class="smallcaps", style="font-variant:small-caps;"}}) end -- if necessary wrap result in <span> tag to format in Small Caps
+
if capture then
    return result, count
+
err_msg = capture .. ' ' .. char;
 +
else
 +
err_msg = char .. ' ' .. 'character';
 +
end
 +
 
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invisible_char', {err_msg, wrap_style ('parameter', param), position}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
return; -- and done with this parameter
 +
end
 +
end
 +
i=i+1; -- bump our index
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
function anchorid(args)
+
 
    local P1 = args[1] or ""
+
--[[--------------------------< A R G U M E N T _ W R A P P E R >----------------------------------------------
    local P2 = args[2] or ""
+
 
    local P3 = args[3] or ""
+
Argument wrapper.  This function provides support for argument mapping defined in the configuration file so that
    local P4 = args[4] or ""
+
multiple names can be transparently aliased to single internal variable.
    local P5 = args[5] or ""
+
 
    return "CITEREF" .. P1 .. P2 .. P3 .. P4 .. P5
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local function argument_wrapper( args )
 +
local origin = {};
 +
 +
return setmetatable({
 +
ORIGIN = function( self, k )
 +
local dummy = self[k]; --force the variable to be loaded.
 +
return origin[k];
 +
end
 +
},
 +
{
 +
__index = function ( tbl, k )
 +
if origin[k] ~= nil then
 +
return nil;
 +
end
 +
 +
local args, list, v = args, cfg.aliases[k];
 +
 +
if type( list ) == 'table' then
 +
v, origin[k] = select_one( args, list, 'redundant_parameters' );
 +
if origin[k] == nil then
 +
origin[k] = ''; -- Empty string, not nil
 +
end
 +
elseif list ~= nil then
 +
v, origin[k] = args[list], list;
 +
else
 +
-- maybe let through instead of raising an error?
 +
-- v, origin[k] = args[k], k;
 +
error( cfg.messages['unknown_argument_map'] );
 +
end
 +
 +
-- Empty strings, not nil;
 +
if v == nil then
 +
v = cfg.defaults[k] or '';
 +
origin[k] = '';
 +
end
 +
 +
tbl = rawset( tbl, k, v );
 +
return v;
 +
end,
 +
});
 
end
 
end
  
function refid(args)
+
--[[--------------------------< V A L I D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------------
    local p = args.p or ""
+
Looks for a parameter's name in the whitelist.
    local pp = args.pp or ""
+
 
    local loc = args.loc or ""
+
Parameters in the whitelist can have three values:
    return anchorid(args) .. p .. pp .. loc   
+
true - active, supported parameters
 +
false - deprecated, supported parameters
 +
nil - unsupported parameters
 +
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function validate( name )
 +
local name = tostring( name );
 +
local state = whitelist.basic_arguments[ name ];
 +
 +
-- Normal arguments
 +
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
 +
if false == state then
 +
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
 +
return true;
 +
end
 +
 +
-- Arguments with numbers in them
 +
name = name:gsub( "%d+", "#" ); -- replace digit(s) with # (last25 becomes last#
 +
state = whitelist.numbered_arguments[ name ];
 +
if true == state then return true; end -- valid actively supported parameter
 +
if false == state then
 +
deprecated_parameter (name); -- parameter is deprecated but still supported
 +
return true;
 +
end
 +
 +
return false; -- Not supported because not found or name is set to nil
 
end
 
end
  
function name(args)
+
 
    local P1 = args[1] or ""
+
--[[--------------------------< N O W R A P _ D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------
    if ( args[5] ~= nil) then
+
 
        return P1 .. " et al."
+
When date is YYYY-MM-DD format wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>YYYY-MM-DD</span>.  When date is DD MMMM YYYY or is
    else
+
MMMM DD, YYYY then wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>DD MMMM</span> YYYY or <span ...>MMMM DD,</span> YYYY
        local P2 = args[2] or ""
+
 
        local P3 = args[3] or ""
+
DOES NOT yet support MMMM YYYY or any of the date ranges.
        local P4 = args[4] or ""
+
 
        if ( args[4] ~= nil ) then
+
]]
            P4 = " " .. P4
+
 
            P3 = ", & " .. P3
+
local function nowrap_date (date)
            P2 = ", " .. P2
+
local cap='';
        elseif ( args[3] ~= nil ) then
+
local cap2='';
            P3 = " " .. P3
+
 
            P2 = " & " .. P2
+
if date:match("^%d%d%d%d%-%d%d%-%d%d$") then
        elseif ( args[2] ~= nil ) then
+
date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap1'], date);
            P2 = " " .. P2           
+
        end
+
elseif date:match("^%a+%s*%d%d?,%s+%d%d%d%d$") or date:match ("^%d%d?%s*%a+%s+%d%d%d%d$") then
        return P1 .. P2 .. P3 .. P4
+
cap, cap2 = string.match (date, "^(.*)%s+(%d%d%d%d)$");
    end
+
date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap2'], {cap, cap2});
 +
end
 +
 +
return date;
 
end
 
end
  
function crossref(frame, args)
+
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ T I T L E T Y P E >----------------------------------------------------
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
 
    local LB = config.BracketLeft or ""
+
This function sets default title types (equivalent to the citation including |type=<default value>) for those templates that have defaults.
    local RB = config.BracketRight or ""
+
Also handles the special case where it is desirable to omit the title type from the rendered citation (|type=none).
    local anchor = args.ref or args.Ref or anchorid(args)
+
 
    local text = name(args)
+
]]
    local loc = args.loc
+
 
    local page
+
local function set_titletype (cite_class, title_type)
    local pages = args.pp or args.pages
+
if is_set(title_type) then
    if pages == nil or pages == '' then
+
if "none" == title_type then
        page = args.p or args.page;
+
title_type = ""; -- if |type=none then type parameter not displayed
    end
+
end
    if nil == loc then loc = "" else loc = " " .. loc end
+
return title_type; -- if |type= has been set to any other value use that value
    if ( page ~= nil ) then
+
end
        local pagesep = config.PageSep or ", p. "
+
 
        loc = loc .. pagesep .. page
+
return cfg.title_types [cite_class] or ''; -- set template's default title type; else empty string for concatenation
    end
 
    if ( pages ~= nil ) then
 
        local pagessep = config.PagesSep or ", pp. "
 
        loc = loc .. pagessep .. pages
 
    end      
 
    local pagename = args.pagename or ""
 
    local ps = args.Postscript or ""
 
    return LB .. "[[" .. pagename .. "#" .. anchor .. "|" .. text .. "]]" .. loc .. RB .. ps
 
 
end
 
end
   
+
 
function extractauthors(args)
+
 
    local authors = {};
+
--[[--------------------------< H Y P H E N _ T O _ D A S H >--------------------------------------------------
    local i = 1;
+
 
    local last;
+
Converts a hyphen to a dash
   
+
 
    while true do
+
]]
        last = args["author" .. i .. "-last"] or args["author-last" .. i] or args["last" .. i] or args["surname" .. i] or args["Author" .. i] or args["author" .. i]
+
 
        if ( last and "" < last ) then -- just in case someone passed in an empty parameter
+
local function hyphen_to_dash( str )
            authors[i] = {
+
if not is_set(str) or str:match( "[%[%]{}<>]" ) ~= nil then
                last = last,
+
return str;
                first = args["author" .. i .. "-first"] or args["author-first" .. i] or args["first" .. i] or args["given" .. i],
+
end
                link = args["author" .. i .. "-link"] or args["author-link" .. i] or args["author" .. i .. "link"] or args["authorlink" .. i],
+
return str:gsub( '-', '–' );
                mask = args["author" .. i .. "-mask"] or args["author-mask" .. i] or args["author" .. i .. "mask"] or args["authormask" .. i]
 
            }
 
        else
 
            break;
 
        end
 
        i = i + 1;
 
    end
 
    return authors;
 
 
end
 
end
  
function extracteditors(args)
+
 
    local editors = {};
+
--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ J O I N >------------------------------------------------------------
    local i = 1;
+
 
    local last;
+
Joins a sequence of strings together while checking for duplicate separation characters.
   
+
 
    while true do
+
]]
        local last = args["editor" .. i .. "-last"] or args["editor-last" .. i] or args["EditorSurname" .. i] or args["Editor" .. i] or args["editor" .. i]
+
 
        if ( last and "" < last ) then -- just in case someone passed in an empty parameter
+
local function safe_join( tbl, duplicate_char )
            editors[i] = {
+
--[[
                last = last,
+
Note: we use string functions here, rather than ustring functions.
                first = args["editor" .. i .. "-first"] or args["editor-first" .. i] or args["EditorGiven" .. i],
+
                link = args["editor" .. i .. "-link"] or args["editor-link" .. i] or args["editor" .. i .. "link"] or args["editorlink" .. i],
+
This has considerably faster performance and should work correctly as
                mask = args["editor" .. i .. "-mask"] or args["editor-mask" .. i] or args["editor" .. i .. "mask"] or args["editormask" .. i]
+
long as the duplicate_char is strict ASCII.  The strings
            }
+
in tbl may be ASCII or UTF8.
        else
+
]]
            break;
+
        end
+
local str = ''; -- the output string
        i = i + 1;
+
local comp = ''; -- what does 'comp' mean?
    end
+
local end_chr = '';
    return editors;
+
local trim;
 +
for _, value in ipairs( tbl ) do
 +
if value == nil then value = ''; end
 +
 +
if str == '' then -- if output string is empty
 +
str = value; -- assign value to it (first time through the loop)
 +
elseif value ~= '' then
 +
if value:sub(1,1) == '<' then -- Special case of values enclosed in spans and other markup.
 +
comp = value:gsub( "%b<>", "" ); -- remove html markup (<span>string</span> -> string)
 +
else
 +
comp = value;
 +
end
 +
-- typically duplicate_char is sepc
 +
if comp:sub(1,1) == duplicate_char then -- is first charactier same as duplicate_char? why test first character?
 +
--  Because individual string segments often (always?) begin with terminal punct for th
 +
--  preceding segment: 'First element' .. 'sepc next element' .. etc?
 +
trim = false;
 +
end_chr = str:sub(-1,-1); -- get the last character of the output string
 +
-- str = str .. "<HERE(enchr=" .. end_chr.. ")" -- debug stuff?
 +
if end_chr == duplicate_char then -- if same as separator
 +
str = str:sub(1,-2); -- remove it
 +
elseif end_chr == "'" then -- if it might be wikimarkup
 +
if str:sub(-3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "''" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc''
 +
str = str:sub(1, -4) .. "''"; -- remove them and add back ''
 +
elseif str:sub(-5,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]''" then -- if last five chars of str are sepc]]''
 +
trim = true; -- why? why do this and next differently from previous?
 +
elseif str:sub(-4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]''" then -- if last four chars of str are sepc]''
 +
trim = true; -- same question
 +
end
 +
elseif end_chr == "]" then -- if it might be wikimarkup
 +
if str:sub(-3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]" then -- if last three chars of str are sepc]] wikilink
 +
trim = true;
 +
elseif str:sub(-2,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]" then -- if last two chars of str are sepc] external link
 +
trim = true;
 +
elseif str:sub(-4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "'']" then -- normal case when |url=something & |title=Title.
 +
trim = true;
 +
end
 +
elseif end_chr == " " then -- if last char of output string is a space
 +
if str:sub(-2,-1) == duplicate_char .. " " then -- if last two chars of str are <sepc><space>
 +
str = str:sub(1,-3); -- remove them both
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if trim then
 +
if value ~= comp then -- value does not equal comp when value contains html markup
 +
local dup2 = duplicate_char;
 +
if dup2:match( "%A" ) then dup2 = "%" .. dup2; end -- if duplicate_char not a letter then escape it
 +
 +
value = value:gsub( "(%b<>)" .. dup2, "%1", 1 ) -- remove duplicate_char if it follows html markup
 +
else
 +
value = value:sub( 2, -1 ); -- remove duplicate_char when it is first character
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
str = str .. value; --add it to the output string
 +
end
 +
end
 +
return str;
 +
end 
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< I S _ S U F F I X >------------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
returns true is suffix is properly formed Jr, Sr, or ordinal in the range 2–9. Puncutation not allowed.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function is_suffix (suffix)
 +
if in_array (suffix, {'Jr', 'Sr', '2nd', '3rd'}) or suffix:match ('^%dth$') then
 +
return true;
 +
end
 +
return false;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< I S _ G O O D _ V A N C _ N A M E >--------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
For Vancouver Style, author/editor names are supposed to be rendered in Latin (read ASCII) characters. When a name
 +
uses characters that contain diacritical marks, those characters are to converted to the corresponding Latin character.
 +
When a name is written using a non-Latin alphabet or logogram, that name is to be transliterated into Latin characters.
 +
These things are not currently possible in this module so are left to the editor to do.
 +
 
 +
This test allows |first= and |last= names to contain any of the letters defined in the four Unicode Latin character sets
 +
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0000.pdf C0 Controls and Basic Latin] 0041–005A, 0061–007A
 +
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0080.pdf C1 Controls and Latin-1 Supplement] 00C0–00D6, 00D8–00F6, 00F8–00FF
 +
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0100.pdf Latin Extended-A] 0100–017F
 +
[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0180.pdf Latin Extended-B] 0180–01BF, 01C4–024F
 +
 
 +
|lastn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, and apostrophes. (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
 +
|firstn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, apostrophes, and periods
 +
 
 +
This original test:
 +
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%']*$") or nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%'%.]+[2-6%a]*$") then
 +
was written ouside of the code editor and pasted here because the code editor gets confused between character insertion point and cursor position.
 +
The test has been rewritten to use decimal character escape sequence for the individual bytes of the unicode characters so that it is not necessary
 +
to use an external editor to maintain this code.
 +
 
 +
\195\128-\195\150 – À-Ö (U+00C0–U+00D6 – C0 controls)
 +
\195\152-\195\182 – Ø-ö (U+00D8-U+00F6 – C0 controls)
 +
\195\184-\198\191 – ø-ƿ (U+00F8-U+01BF – C0 controls, Latin extended A & B)
 +
\199\132-\201\143 – DŽ-ɏ (U+01C4-U+024F – Latin extended B)
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function is_good_vanc_name (last, first)
 +
local first, suffix = first:match ('(.-),?%s*([%dJS][%drndth]+)%.?$') or first; -- if first has something that looks like a generational suffix, get it
 +
 
 +
if is_set (suffix) then
 +
if not is_suffix (suffix) then
 +
add_vanc_error ('suffix');
 +
return false; -- not a name with an appropriate suffix
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%']*$") or
 +
nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%'%.]*$") then
 +
add_vanc_error ('non-Latin character');
 +
return false; -- not a string of latin characters; Vancouver requires Romanization
 +
end;
 +
return true;
 
end
 
end
  
function citation0(frame, args)
+
--[[--------------------------< R E D U C E _ T O _ I N I T I A L S >------------------------------------------
    local config = {};
+
 
    for k, v in pairs( frame.args ) do -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
Attempts to convert names to initials in support of |name-list-format=vanc. 
        config[k] = v;
+
 
    end
+
Names in |firstn= may be separated by spaces or hyphens, or for initials, a period. See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35062/.
 +
 
 +
Vancouver style requires family rank designations (Jr, II, III, etc) to be rendered as Jr, 2nd, 3rd, etc.  See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35085/.
 +
This code only accepts and understands generational suffix in the Vancouver format because Roman numerals look like, and can be mistaken for, initials.
 +
 
 +
This function uses ustring functions because firstname initials may be any of the unicode Latin characters accepted by is_good_vanc_name ().
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function reduce_to_initials(first)
 +
local name, suffix = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+) ([%dJS][%drndth]+)$");
 +
 
 +
if not name then -- if not initials and a suffix
 +
name = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+)$"); -- is it just intials?
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if name then -- if first is initials with or without suffix
 +
if 3 > name:len() then -- if one or two initials
 +
if suffix then -- if there is a suffix
 +
if is_suffix (suffix) then -- is it legitimate?
 +
return first; -- one or two initials and a valid suffix so nothing to do
 +
else
 +
add_vanc_error ('suffix'); -- one or two initials with invalid suffix so error message
 +
return first; -- and return first unmolested
 +
end
 +
else
 +
return first; -- one or two initials without suffix; nothing to do
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end -- if here then name has 3 or more uppercase letters so treat them as a word
 +
 
 +
 
 +
local initials, names = {}, {}; -- tables to hold name parts and initials
 +
local i = 1; -- counter for number of initials
  
    --------------------------------------------------- Get parameters   
+
names = mw.text.split (first, '[%s,]+'); -- split into a table of names and possible suffix
    local PPrefix = config.PPrefix or "p.&nbsp;"
 
    local PPPrefix = config.PPPrefix or "pp.&nbsp;"
 
    if ( nil ~= args.nopp ) then PPPrefix = "" PPrefix = "" end
 
   
 
    -- Transfer unnumbered arguments to numbered arguments if necessary.
 
    args["author1"] = args.author1 or args.author or args.authors
 
    args["author1-last"] = args["author1-last"] or args["author-last"] or args["last"]
 
    args["author1-first"] = args["author1-first"] or args["author-first"]
 
      or args.first or args.first1 or args.given or args.given1
 
    args["author1-link"] = args["author1-link"] or args["author-link"]
 
    args["author1-mask"] = args["author1-mask"] or args["author-mask"]
 
    args["author1link"] = args["author1link"] or args["authorlink"]   
 
    args["editor1"] = args["editor1"] or args["editor"]
 
    args["editor1-last"] = args["editor1-last"] or args["editor-last"]
 
    args["editor1-first"] = args["editor1-first"] or args["editor-first"]
 
    args["editor1-link"] = args["editor1-link"] or args["editor-link"]
 
    args["editor1-mask"] = args["editor1-mask"] or args["editor-mask"]
 
    args["editor1link"] = args["editor1link"] or args["editorlink"]   
 
  
    -- Pick out the relevant fields from the arguments. Different citation templates define different field names for the same underlying things.   
+
while names[i] do -- loop through the table
    local Authors = args.authors
+
if 1 < i and names[i]:match ('[%dJS][%drndth]+%.?$') then -- if not the first name, and looks like a suffix (may have trailing dot)
    local i  
+
names[i] = names[i]:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove terminal dot if present
    local a = extractauthors( args );
+
if is_suffix (names[i]) then -- if a legitimate suffix
 +
table.insert (initials, ' ' .. names[i]); -- add a separator space, insert at end of initials table
 +
break; -- and done because suffix must fall at the end of a name
 +
end -- no error message if not a suffix; possibly because of Romanization
 +
end
 +
if 3 > i then
 +
table.insert (initials, mw.ustring.sub(names[i],1,1)); -- insert the intial at end of initials table
 +
end
 +
i = i+1; -- bump the counter
 +
end
 +
 +
return table.concat(initials) -- Vancouver format does not include spaces.
 +
end
  
    local Coauthors = args.coauthors or args.coauthor
+
--[[--------------------------< L I S T  _ P E O P L E >-------------------------------------------------------
    local Others = args.others
 
    local EditorMask = args.editormask or args["editor-mask"]
 
    local EditorFormat = args["editor-format"] or args.editorformat
 
    local Editors = args.editors
 
    local e = extracteditors( args );
 
  
    local Year = args.year
+
Formats a list of people (e.g. authors / editors)  
    local PublicationDate = args.publicationdate or args["publication-date"]
 
    local OrigYear = args.origyear
 
    local Date = args.date
 
    local LayDate = args.laydate
 
    ------------------------------------------------- Get title data
 
    local Title = args.title or args.encyclopaedia or args.encyclopedia or args.dictionary
 
    local BookTitle = args.booktitle
 
    local Conference = args.conference
 
    local TransTitle = args.trans_title
 
    local TitleNote = args.department
 
    local TitleLink = args.titlelink or args.episodelink
 
    local Chapter = args.chapter or args.contribution or args.entry
 
    local ChapterLink = args.chapterlink
 
    local TransChapter = args["trans-chapter"] or args.trans_chapter
 
    local TitleType = args.type
 
    local ArchiveURL = args["archive-url"] or args.archiveurl
 
    local URL = args.url
 
    local ChapterURL = args["chapter-url"] or args.chapterurl
 
    local ConferenceURL = args["conference-url"] or args.conferenceurl
 
    local Periodical = args.journal or args.newspaper or args.magazine or args.work or args.periodical or args.encyclopedia or args.encyclopaedia
 
    if ( config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) then
 
        if ( args.article and args.article ~= "") then
 
            if ( Title and Title ~= "") then Periodical = Title end
 
            Chapter = args.article
 
            TransChapter = TransTitle
 
            Title = ""           
 
        elseif ( Chapter == nil or Chapter == '' ) then
 
            if Title ~= args.encyclopedia then
 
                Chapter = Title
 
                TransChapter = TransTitle
 
                Title = ""           
 
            end           
 
        end
 
        if ( Periodical and Periodical ~= "") then
 
            if Periodical == Title or Periodical == Chapter then Periodical = '' end
 
        end
 
    end
 
    local Series = args.series or args.version
 
    local Volume = args.volume
 
    local Issue = args.issue or args.number
 
    local Position = nil
 
    local Page
 
    local Pages = args.pages
 
    if Pages == nil or Pages == '' then
 
        Page = args.page  -- allows Pages to override Page
 
    else
 
        Pages = hyphentodash( Pages );
 
    end
 
  
    local PP = args.pp
+
]]
    local At = args.at
 
    local Edition = args.edition
 
    local PublicationPlace = args["publication-place"] or args.publicationplace or args.place or args.location
 
    local Location = PublicationPlace
 
    local PublisherName = args.publisher
 
    local SubscriptionRequired = args.subscription
 
    local Via = args.via
 
    local AccessDate = args["access-date"] or args.accessdate
 
    local ArchiveDate = args["archive-date"] or args.archivedate
 
    local Agency = args.agency
 
    local DeadURL = args.deadurl
 
    local Language = args.language or args["in"]
 
    local Format = args.format
 
    local Ref = args.ref or args.Ref
 
    local ARXIV = args.arxiv or args.ARXIV
 
    local ASIN = args.asin or args.ASIN
 
    local ASINTLD = args["ASIN-TLD"] or args["asin-tld"]
 
    local BIBCODE = args.bibcode or args.BIBCODE
 
    local DOI = args.doi or args.DOI
 
    local DoiBroken = args.doi_inactivedate or args.doi_brokendate or args.DoiBroken
 
    local ID = args.id or args.ID
 
    local ISBN = args.isbn13 or args.isbn or args.ISBN
 
    local ISSN = args.issn or args.ISSN
 
    local JFM = args.jfm or args.JFM
 
    local JSTOR = args.jstor or args.JSTOR
 
    local LCCN = args.lccn or args.LCCN
 
    local MR = args.mr or args.MR
 
    local OCLC = args.oclc or args.OCLC
 
    local OL = args.ol or args.OL
 
    local OSTI = args.osti or args.OSTI
 
    local PMC = args.pmc or args.PMC
 
    local PMID = args.pmid or args.PMID
 
    local RFC = args.rfc or args.RFC
 
    local SSRN = args.ssrn or args.SSRN
 
    local ZBL = args.zbl or args.ZBL
 
    local Quote = args.quote or args.quotation
 
    local PostScript = args.postscript
 
    local LaySummary = args.laysummary
 
    local LaySource = args.laysource
 
    local Transcript = args.transcript
 
    local TranscriptURL = args["transcript-url"] or args.transcripturl
 
    local sepc = args.separator
 
  
    if ( config.CitationClass == "journal" ) then
+
local function list_people(control, people, etal)
        if (URL == nil or URL == "") then
+
local sep;
          if (PMC ~= nil and PMC ~="")
+
local namesep;
            then URL="http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC" .. PMC
+
local format = control.format
            else URL=""
+
local maximum = control.maximum
          end
+
local lastauthoramp = control.lastauthoramp;
        end
+
local text = {}
    elseif ( config.CitationClass == "citation" ) then
 
        sepc = ","
 
        if ( Ref == nil ) then Ref = "harv" end
 
    end
 
    if ( sepc == nil ) then sepc = "." end
 
    if ( DeadURL == nil ) then DeadURL = "yes" end
 
  
    -- At this point fields may be nil if they weren't specified in the template use.  We can use that fact.
+
if 'vanc' == format then -- Vancouver-like author/editor name styling?
   
+
sep = ','; -- name-list separator between authors is a comma
    -- Account for the oddity that is {{cite conference}}, before generation of COinS data.
+
namesep = ' '; -- last/first separator is a space
    if ( BookTitle ) then
+
elseif 'mla' == control.mode then
        Chapter = Title
+
sep = ','; -- name-list separator between authors is a comma
        ChapterLink = TitleLink
+
namesep = ', ' -- last/first separator is <comma><space>
        TransChapter = TransTitle
 
        Title = BookTitle
 
        TitleLink = nil
 
        TransTitle = nil
 
    end
 
    -- Account for the oddity that is {{cite episode}}, before generation of COinS data.
 
    if config.CitationClass == "episode" then
 
        local AirDate = args.airdate
 
        local SeriesLink = args.serieslink
 
        local Season = args.season
 
        local SeriesNumber = args.seriesnumber or args.seriesno
 
        local Network = args.network
 
        local Station = args.station
 
        local s = {}
 
        if Issue ~= nil then table.insert(s, "episode " .. Issue) Issue = nil end
 
        if Season ~= nil then table.insert(s, "season " .. Season) end
 
        if SeriesNumber ~= nil then table.insert(s, "series " .. SeriesNumber) end
 
        local n = {}
 
        if Network ~= nil then table.insert(n, Network) end
 
        if Station ~= nil then table.insert(n, Station) end
 
        Date = Date or AirDate
 
        Chapter = Title
 
        ChapterLink = TitleLink
 
        TransChapter = TransTitle
 
        Title = Series
 
        TitleLink = SeriesLink
 
        TransTitle = nil
 
        local Sep = args["series-separator"] or args["separator"] or ". "
 
        Series = table.concat(s, Sep)
 
        ID = table.concat(n, Sep)
 
    end
 
   
 
    -- These data form a COinS tag (see <http://ocoins.info/>) which allows automated tools to parse the citation information.
 
    local OCinSdata = {} -- COinS metadata excluding id, bibcode, doi, etc.
 
    local ctx_ver = "Z39.88-2004"
 
    OCinSdata.rft_val_fmt = "info:ofi/fmt:kev:mtx:book"
 
    if ( nil ~= Periodical ) then
 
        OCinSdata.rft_val_fmt = "info:ofi/fmt:kev:mtx:journal"
 
        OCinSdata["rft.genre"] = "article"
 
        OCinSdata["rft.jtitle"] = Periodical
 
        if ( nil ~= Title ) then OCinSdata["rft.atitle"] = Title end
 
    end
 
    if ( nil ~= Chapter and "" ~= Chapter) then
 
        OCinSdata.rft_val_fmt = "info:ofi/fmt:kev:mtx:book"
 
        OCinSdata["rft.genre"] = "bookitem"
 
        OCinSdata["rft.btitle"] = Chapter
 
        if ( nil ~= Title ) then OCinSdata["rft.atitle"] = Title end
 
    else
 
        OCinSdata["rft.genre"] = "book"
 
    if ( nil ~= Title ) then OCinSdata["rft.btitle"] = Title end
 
    end
 
    OCinSdata["rft.place"] = PublicationPlace
 
    OCinSdata["rft.date"] = Date or Year or PublicationDate
 
    OCinSdata["rft.series"] = Series
 
    OCinSdata["rft.volume"] = Volume
 
    OCinSdata["rft.issue"] = Issue
 
    OCinSdata["rft.pages"] = Page or Pages or At
 
    OCinSdata["rft.edition"] = Edition
 
    OCinSdata["rft.pub"] = PublisherName
 
    OCinSdata["rft.isbn"] = ISBN
 
    OCinSdata["rft.issn"] = ISSN
 
    OCinSdata["rft.jfm"] = JFM
 
    OCinSdata["rft.jstor"] = JSTOR
 
    OCinSdata["rft.lccn"] = LCCN
 
    OCinSdata["rft.mr"] = MR
 
    OCinSdata.rft_id = URL or ChapterURL
 
    if ( nil ~= a[1] and nil ~= a[1].last) then
 
    local last = a[1].last
 
local first = a[1].first
 
OCinSdata["rft.aulast"] = last
 
        if ( nil ~= first ) then  
 
    OCinSdata["rft.aufirst"] = first
 
    OCinSdata["rft.au"] = last .. (args.NameSep or ", ") .. first
 
 
else
 
else
    OCinSdata["rft.au"] = last
+
sep = ';' -- name-list separator between authors is a semicolon
        end
+
namesep = ', ' -- last/first separator is <comma><space>
    end
+
end
    local OCinSids = {} -- COinS data only for id, bibcode, doi, pmid, etc.
+
    OCinSids["info:arxiv"] = ARXIV
+
if sep:sub(-1,-1) ~= " " then sep = sep .. " " end
    OCinSids["info:asin"] = ASIN
+
if is_set (maximum) and maximum < 1 then return "", 0; end -- returned 0 is for EditorCount; not used for authors
    OCinSids["info:bibcode"] = BIBCODE
+
    OCinSids["info:doi"] = DOI
+
for i,person in ipairs(people) do
    OCinSids["info:oclcnum"] = OCLC
+
if is_set(person.last) then
    OCinSids["info:olnum"] = OL
+
local mask = person.mask
    OCinSids["info:osti"] = OSTI
+
local one
    OCinSids["info:pmc"] = PMC
+
local sep_one = sep;
    OCinSids["info:pmid"] = PMID
+
if is_set (maximum) and i > maximum then
    OCinSids["info:rfc"] = RFC
+
etal = true;
    OCinSids["info:ssrn"] = SSRN
+
break;
    OCinSids["info:zbl"] = ZBL
+
elseif (mask ~= nil) then
    local OCinStitle = "ctx_ver=" .. ctx_ver  -- such as "Z39.88-2004"
+
local n = tonumber(mask)
    for name,value in pairs(OCinSids) do
+
if (n ~= nil) then
        OCinStitle = OCinStitle .. "&rft_id=" .. mw.uri.encode(name .. "/" .. value)
+
one = string.rep("&mdash;",n)
    end
+
else
    for name,value in pairs(OCinSdata) do
+
one = mask;
        OCinStitle = OCinStitle .. "&" .. name .. "=" .. mw.uri.encode(value)
+
sep_one = " ";
    end
+
end
    OCinStitle = OCinStitle .. "&rfr_id=info:sid/en.wikipedia.org:"
+
else
      .. config.fullpagename  -- end COinS data by page's non-encoded pagename
+
one = person.last
 +
local first = person.first
 +
if is_set(first) then
 +
if 'mla' == control.mode then
 +
if i == 1 then -- for mla
 +
one = one .. namesep .. first; -- first name last, first
 +
else -- all other names
 +
one = first .. ' ' .. one; -- first last
 +
end
 +
else
 +
if ( "vanc" == format ) then -- if vancouver format
 +
one = one:gsub ('%.', ''); -- remove periods from surnames (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
 +
if not person.corporate and is_good_vanc_name (one, first) then -- and name is all Latin characters; corporate authors not tested
 +
first = reduce_to_initials(first) -- attempt to convert first name(s) to initials
 +
end
 +
end
 +
one = one .. namesep .. first;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set(person.link) and person.link ~= control.page_name then
 +
one = "[[" .. person.link .. "|" .. one .. "]]" -- link author/editor if this page is not the author's/editor's page
 +
end
 +
end
 +
table.insert( text, one )
 +
table.insert( text, sep_one )
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local count = #text / 2; -- (number of names + number of separators) divided by 2
 +
if count > 0 then
 +
if count > 1 and is_set(lastauthoramp) and not etal then
 +
if 'mla' == control.mode then
 +
text[#text-2] = ", and "; -- replace last separator with ', and ' text
 +
else
 +
text[#text-2] = " & "; -- replace last separator with ampersand text
 +
end
 +
end
 +
text[#text] = nil; -- erase the last separator
 +
end
 +
 +
local result = table.concat(text) -- construct list
 +
if etal and is_set (result) then -- etal may be set by |display-authors=etal but we might not have a last-first list
 +
result = result .. sep .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- we've go a last-first list and etal so add et al.
 +
end
 +
 +
return result, count
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< A N C H O R _ I D >------------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Generates a CITEREF anchor ID if we have at least one name or a date.  Otherwise returns an empty string.
  
    -- Now perform various field substitutions.
+
namelist is one of the contributor-, author-, or editor-name lists chosen in that order. year is Year or anchor_year.
    -- We also add leading spaces and surrounding markup and punctuation to the various parts of the citation, but only when they are non-nil.
 
    if ( Authors == nil ) then
 
        local AuthorNameSep = args["author-name-separator"] or args["name-separator"] or "&#44;"
 
        AuthorNameSep = AuthorNameSep .. " "
 
        local AuthorSep = args["author-separator"] or args["separator"] or "&#59;"
 
        AuthorSep = AuthorSep .. " "
 
        local AuthorFormat = args["author-format"] or args.authorformat
 
        local AuthorMaximum = tonumber(args["display-authors"] or args.displayauthors) or 8
 
        local control = { sep = AuthorSep, namesep = AuthorNameSep, format = AuthorFormat, maximum = AuthorMaximum }
 
        Authors = listpeople(control, a)
 
    end
 
    local EditorCount
 
    if ( Editors == nil ) then
 
        local EditorNameSep = args["editor-name-separator"] or args["name-separator"] or "&#44; "
 
        local EditorSep = args["editor-separator"] or args["separator"] or "&#59; "
 
        local EditorFormat = args["editor-format"] or args.editorformat
 
        local EditorMaximum = tonumber(args["display-editors"] or args.displayeditors) or 3
 
        local control = { sep = EditorSep, namesep = EditorNameSep, format = EditorFormat, maximum = EditorMaximum }
 
        Editors, EditorCount = listpeople(control, e)
 
    else
 
        EditorCount = 1;
 
    end
 
    if ( Date == nil or Date == "") then
 
--  there's something hinky with how this adds dashes to perfectly-good free-standing years
 
--[[        Date = Year
 
        if ( Date ~= nil ) then
 
            local Month = args.month
 
            if ( Month == nil ) then
 
                local Began = args.began
 
                local Ended = args.ended
 
                if Began ~= nil and Ended ~= nil then
 
                    Month = Began .. "&ndash;" .. Ended
 
                else
 
                    Month = "&ndash;"
 
                end
 
            end
 
            Date = Month .. " " .. Date
 
            local Day = args.day
 
            if ( Day ~= nil ) then Date = Day .. " " .. Date end
 
        end
 
]] -- so let's use the original version for now
 
        Date = Year
 
        if ( Date ~= nil and Date ~="") then
 
            local Month = args.month
 
            if ( Month ~= nil and Month ~= "") then
 
                Date = Month .. " " .. Date
 
                local Day = args.day
 
                if ( Day ~= nil ) then Date = Day .. " " .. Date end
 
                else Month = ""
 
            end
 
            else Date = ""
 
        end
 
    end
 
    if ( PublicationDate == Date or PublicationDate == Year ) then PublicationDate = nil end
 
    if( (Date == nil or Date == "") and PublicationDate ~= nil ) then
 
        Date = PublicationDate;
 
        PublicationDate = nil;
 
    end   
 
  
    -- Captures the value for Date prior to adding parens or other textual transformations
+
]]
    local DateIn = Date
+
local function anchor_id (namelist, year)
 +
local names={}; -- a table for the one to four names and year
 +
for i,v in ipairs (namelist) do -- loop through the list and take up to the first four last names
 +
names[i] = v.last
 +
if i == 4 then break end -- if four then done
 +
end
 +
table.insert (names, year); -- add the year at the end
 +
local id = table.concat(names); -- concatenate names and year for CITEREF id
 +
if is_set (id) then -- if concatenation is not an empty string
 +
return "CITEREF" .. id; -- add the CITEREF portion
 +
else
 +
return ''; -- return an empty string; no reason to include CITEREF id in this citation
 +
end
 +
end
  
    if ( Format ~= nil and Format ~="" ) then
 
        Format = " (" .. Format .. ")" else Format = "" end
 
    if ( ArchiveURL and "" < ArchiveURL ) then
 
        if ( DeadURL ~= "no" ) then
 
          local temp = URL
 
          URL = ArchiveURL
 
        end
 
    end
 
    if ( TransTitle and "" < TransTitle ) then TransTitle = " [" .. TransTitle .. "&#93;" else TransTitle = "" end
 
    if ( TransChapter and "" < TransChapter ) then TransChapter = " [" .. TransChapter .. "&#93;" else TransChapter = "" end
 
    if ( Chapter and "" < Chapter ) then
 
        if ( ChapterLink and "" < ChapterLink ) then Chapter = "[[" .. ChapterLink .. "|" .. Chapter .. "]]" end
 
        if ( Periodical and "" < Periodical
 
            and config.CitationClass ~= "encyclopaedia"
 
        ) then
 
            Chapter = "''" .. safeforitalics(Chapter) .. "''"
 
        else
 
            Chapter = "\"" .. Chapter .. "\""
 
        end
 
        Chapter = Chapter .. TransChapter
 
        if ( ChapterLink == nil ) then
 
            if ( ChapterURL and "" < ChapterURL ) then
 
                Chapter = "[" .. ChapterURL .. " " .. safeforurl( Chapter )  .. "]"
 
            elseif ( URL and "" < URL ) then
 
                Chapter = "[" .. URL .. " " .. safeforurl( Chapter ) .. "]" .. Format
 
                URL = nil
 
                Format = ""
 
            end
 
        end
 
        Chapter = Chapter .. sepc .. " " -- with end-space
 
    else
 
        Chapter = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( Title and "" < Title ) then
 
        if ( TitleLink and "" < TitleLink ) then
 
            Title = "[[" .. TitleLink .. "|" .. Title .. "]]" end
 
        if ( Periodical and "" < Periodical ) then
 
            Title = "\"" .. Title .. "\""
 
        elseif ( config.CitationClass == "web"
 
              or config.CitationClass == "news" ) then
 
            Title = "\"" .. Title .. "\""
 
        else
 
            Title = "''" .. safeforitalics(Title) .. "''"
 
        end
 
        Title = Title .. TransTitle
 
        if ( TitleLink == nil and URL and "" < URL ) then
 
            Title = "[" .. URL .. " " .. safeforurl( Title ) .. "]" .. Format
 
            URL = nil
 
            Format = ''
 
        end
 
    else
 
        Title = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( Conference ~= nil and Conference ~="" ) then
 
        if ( ConferenceURL ~= nil ) then
 
            Conference = "[" .. ConferenceURL .. " " .. safeforurl( Conference ) .. "]"
 
        end
 
        Conference = " " .. Conference
 
    else
 
        Conference = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( nil ~= Position or nil ~= Page or nil ~= Pages ) then At = nil end
 
    if ( nil == Position and "" ~= Position ) then
 
        local Minutes = args.minutes
 
        if ( nil ~= Minutes ) then
 
            Position = " " .. Minutes .. " minutes in"
 
        else
 
            local Time = args.time
 
            if ( nil ~= Time ) then
 
                local TimeCaption = args.timecaption or "Event occurs at"
 
                Position = " " .. TimeCaption .. " " .. Time
 
            else
 
                Position = ""
 
            end
 
        end
 
    else
 
        Position = " " .. Position
 
    end
 
    if ( nil == Page or "" == Page ) then
 
        Page = ""
 
    elseif ( Periodical ~= nil and Periodical ~= "" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "encyclopaedia" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "web" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "book" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "news") then
 
        Page = ": " .. Page
 
    else
 
        Page = sepc .." " .. PPrefix .. Page
 
    end
 
    if ( nil == Pages or "" == Pages) then
 
        Pages = ""
 
    elseif ( Periodical ~= nil and Periodical ~= "" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "encyclopaedia" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "web" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "book" and
 
            config.CitationClass ~= "news") then
 
        Pages = ": " .. Pages
 
    else
 
        if ( tonumber(Pages) ~= nil ) then
 
          Pages = sepc .." " .. PPrefix .. Pages
 
        else Pages = sepc .." " .. PPPrefix .. Pages
 
        end
 
    end
 
    if ( At ~= nil and At ~="") then At = sepc .. " " .. At
 
    else At = "" end
 
    if ( Coauthors == nil ) then Coauthors = "" end
 
    if ( Others ~= nil and Others ~="" ) then
 
        Others = sepc .. " " .. Others else Others = "" end
 
    if ( TitleType ~= nil and TitleType ~="" ) then
 
        TitleType = " (" .. TitleType .. ")" else TitleType = "" end
 
    if ( TitleNote ~= nil and TitleNote ~="" ) then
 
        TitleNote = sepc .. " " .. TitleNote else TitleNote = "" end
 
    if ( PublicationPlace ~= nil and PublicationPlace ~="" ) then
 
        PublicationPlace = PublicationPlace .. ": "
 
        else PublicationPlace = "" end
 
    if ( Language ~= nil and Language ~="" ) then
 
        Language = " (in " .. Language .. ")" else Language = "" end
 
    if ( Edition ~= nil and Edition ~="" ) then
 
        Edition = " (" .. Edition .. " ed.)" else Edition = "" end
 
    if ( Volume ~= nil and Volume ~="" )
 
    then
 
        if ( string.len(Volume) > 4 )
 
          then Volume = sepc .." " .. Volume
 
          else Volume = " <b>" .. Volume .. "</b>"
 
        end
 
    else Volume = "" end
 
    if ( Issue ~= nil and Issue ~="" ) then
 
        Issue = " (" .. Issue .. ")" else Issue = "" end
 
    if ( Series ~= nil and Series ~="" ) then
 
        Series = sepc .. " " .. Series else Series = "" end
 
    if ( OrigYear ~= nil and OrigYear ~="" ) then
 
        OrigYear = " [" .. OrigYear .. "]" else OrigYear = "" end
 
    if ( Agency ~= nil and Agency ~="" ) then
 
        Agency = sepc .. " " .. Agency else Agency = "" end
 
    ------------------------------------ totally unrelated data
 
    if ( Date ~= nil ) then Date = Date else Date = "" end
 
    if ( Via ~= nil and Via ~="" ) then
 
        Via = " &mdash; via " .. Via else Via = "" end
 
    if ( AccessDate ~= nil and AccessDate ~="" )
 
    then local retrv_text = " retrieved "
 
        if (sepc == ".") then retrv_text = " Retrieved " end
 
        AccessDate = '<span class="reference-accessdate">'
 
        .. sepc .. retrv_text .. AccessDate .. '</span>'
 
    else AccessDate = "" end
 
    if ( SubscriptionRequired ~= nil and
 
        SubscriptionRequired ~= "" ) then
 
        SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. z.mw.text.tag({name="span", contents="(subscription required)", params={style="font-size:0.95em; font-size: 90%; color: #555"}})
 
    else
 
        SubscriptionRequired = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( ARXIV ~= nil and ARXIV ~= "" ) then
 
        ARXIV = sepc .. " " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="arXiv",link="arXiv",prefix="http://arxiv.org/abs/",id=ARXIV,separator=":",encode=false}) else ARXIV = "" end
 
    if ( ASIN ~= nil and ASIN ~= "" ) then
 
        ASIN = sepc .. " " .. amazon(frame, ASIN, ASINTLD) else ASIN = "" end
 
    if ( BIBCODE ~= nil and BIBCODE ~= "" ) then
 
        BIBCODE = sepc .. " " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="Bibcode",link="Bibcode",prefix="http://adsabs.harvard.edu/abs/",id=BIBCODE,separator=":"}) else BIBCODE = "" end
 
    if ( DOI ~= nil and DOI ~= "" ) then
 
      DOI = sepc .. " " .. doi(frame, DOI, DoiBroken) else DOI = "" end
 
    if ( ID ~= nil and ID ~="") then ID = sepc .." ".. ID else ID="" end
 
    if ( ISBN ~= nil and ISBN ~= "") then
 
        ISBN = sepc .. " " .. internallinkid(frame, {label="ISBN",link="International Standard Book Number",prefix="Special:BookSources/",id=ISBN}) else ISBN = "" end
 
    if ( ISSN ~= nil and ISSN ~="" ) then
 
        ISSN = sepc .. " " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="ISSN",link="International Standard Serial Number",prefix="//www.worldcat.org/issn/",id=ISSN,encode=false}) else ISSN = "" end
 
    if ( JFM ~= nil and JFM ~="" ) then
 
        JFM = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="JFM",link="Jahrbuch über die Fortschritte der Mathematik",prefix="http://www.zentralblatt-math.org/zmath/en/search/?format=complete&q=an:",id=JFM}) else JFM = "" end
 
    if ( JSTOR ~= nil and JSTOR ~="") then
 
        JSTOR = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="JSTOR",link="JSTOR",prefix="http://www.jstor.org/stable/",id=JSTOR}) else JSTOR = "" end
 
    if ( LCCN ~= nil and LCCN ~="" ) then
 
        LCCN = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="LCCN",link="Library of Congress Control Number",prefix="http://lccn.loc.gov/",id=LCCN,encode=false}) else LCCN = "" end
 
    if ( MR ~= nil and MR ~="" ) then
 
        MR = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="MR",link="Mathematical Reviews",prefix="http://www.ams.org/mathscinet-getitem?mr=",id=MR}) else MR = "" end
 
    if ( OCLC ~= nil and OCLC ~="") then
 
        OCLC = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="OCLC",link="OCLC",prefix="//www.worldcat.org/oclc/",id=OCLC}) else OCLC = "" end
 
    if ( OL ~= nil and OL ~="") then
 
        OL = sepc .." " .. openlibrary(frame, OL) else OL = "" end
 
    if ( OSTI ~= nil and OSTI ~="") then
 
        OSTI = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="OSTI",link="Office of Scientific and Technical Information",prefix="http://www.osti.gov/energycitations/product.biblio.jsp?osti_id=",id=OSTI}) else OSTI = "" end
 
    if ( PMC ~= nil and PMC ~="") then
 
        PMC = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="PMC",link="PubMed Central",prefix="//www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pmc/articles/PMC",suffix=" ",id=PMC}) else PMC = "" end
 
    if ( PMID ~= nil and PMID ~="") then
 
        PMID = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="PMID",link="PubMed Identifier",prefix="//www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed/",id=PMID,encode=false}) else PMID = "" end
 
    if ( RFC ~= nil and RFC ~="") then
 
        RFC = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="RFC",link="Request for Comments",prefix="//tools.ietf.org/html/rfc",id=RFC,encode=false}) else RFC = "" end
 
    if ( SSRN ~= nil and SSRN ~="") then
 
        SSRN = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="SSRN",link="Social Science Research Network",prefix="http://ssrn.com/abstract=",id=SSRN}) else SSRN = "" end
 
    if ( URL ~= nil and URL ~="") then
 
      URL = " " .. url(frame, URL)
 
    else
 
      URL = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( ZBL ~= nil and ZBL ~="") then
 
        ZBL = sepc .." " .. externallinkid(frame, {label="Zbl",link="Zentralblatt MATH",prefix="http://www.zentralblatt-math.org/zmath/en/search/?format=complete&q=an:",id=ZBL}) else ZBL = "" end
 
    if ( Quote and Quote ~="" ) then
 
        if Quote:sub(1,1) == '"' and Quote:sub(-1,-1) == '"' then
 
            Quote = Quote:sub(2,-2);
 
        end
 
       
 
        Quote = sepc .." \"" .. Quote .. "\""
 
        PostScript = ""
 
    else
 
        if ( PostScript == nil) then PostScript = "" end
 
        Quote = ""
 
    end
 
    local Archived
 
    if ( nil ~= ArchiveURL and "" ~= ArchiveURL ) then
 
        if ( ArchiveDate ~= nil and ArchiveDate ~="" ) then
 
            ArchiveDate = " " .. ArchiveDate
 
        else
 
            ArchiveDate = "<span class='error'>If you specify <code>archiveurl=</code>, you must also specify <code>archivedate=</code></span> "
 
        end
 
        local arch_text = " archived"
 
        if (sepc == ".") then arch_text = " Archived" end
 
        if ( "no" == DeadURL ) then
 
            Archived = sepc .. " [" .. ArchiveURL .. arch_text .. "] from the original on" .. ArchiveDate
 
        else
 
            Archived = sepc .. arch_text .. " from [" .. args.url .. " the original] on" .. ArchiveDate
 
        end
 
    else
 
        Archived = ""
 
    end
 
    local Lay
 
    if ( nil ~= LaySummary and "" ~= LaySummary ) then
 
        if ( LayDate ~= nil ) then LayDate = " (" .. LayDate .. ")" else LayDate = "" end
 
        if ( LaySource ~= nil ) then
 
            LaySource = " &ndash; ''" .. safeforitalics(LaySource) .. "''"
 
        else
 
            LaySource = ""
 
        end
 
        Lay = " [" .. LaySummary .. " lay summary]" .. LaySource .. LayDate
 
    else
 
        Lay = ""
 
    end
 
    if ( nil ~= Transcript and "" ~= Transcript ) then
 
        if ( TranscriptURL ~= nil ) then Transcript = "[" .. TranscriptURL .. Transcript .. "]" end
 
    else
 
        Transcript = ""
 
    end
 
    local Publisher = ""
 
    if ( Periodical and Periodical ~= "" and
 
        config.CitationClass ~= "encyclopaedia" and
 
        config.CitationClass ~= "web" ) then
 
        if ( PublicationDate and PublicationDate ~="" )
 
            then PublicationDate = " " .. PublicationDate
 
            else PublicationDate = "" end
 
        if ( PublisherName and PublisherName ~="" ) then
 
            Publisher = " (" .. PublicationPlace .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate .. ")"
 
        else
 
            if (Location ~= nil and Location ~= '') then Publisher= " (" .. Location .. ")"
 
            else Publisher = "" end
 
        end
 
    else
 
        if ( PublicationDate and PublicationDate ~="" ) then
 
            PublicationDate = " (published " .. PublicationDate .. ")"
 
            else PublicationDate = "" end
 
        if ( PublisherName and PublisherName ~="" ) then
 
            Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate
 
        else
 
            if (Location ~= nil and Location ~= '') then Publisher= sepc .. " " .. Location
 
            else Publisher = "" end
 
        end
 
    end
 
    -- Several of the above rely upon detecting this as nil, so do it last.
 
    if ( Periodical ~= nil and Periodical ~="" ) then
 
        if ( Title and Title ~= "") then
 
            Periodical = sepc .. " ''" .. safeforitalics(Periodical) .. "''"
 
        else
 
            Periodical = "''" .. safeforitalics(Periodical) .. "''"
 
        end
 
    else Periodical = "" end
 
  
    -- Piece all bits together at last.  Here, all should be non-nil.
+
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ E T A L >----------------------------------------------------
    -- We build things this way because it is more efficient in LUA
 
    -- not to keep reassigning to the same string variable over and over.
 
  
    local tcommon
+
Evaluates the content of author and editor name parameters for variations on the theme of et al. If found,
    if ( config.CitationClass == "journal" ) then
+
the et al. is removed, a flag is set to true and the function returns the modified name and the flag.
        tcommon = safejoin( {Title, TitleNote, Format, TitleType, Conference, Periodical, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Others, Volume, Issue, Position }, sepc );
 
    elseif ( config.CitationClass == "citation" ) or (config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) then
 
        tcommon = safejoin( {Title, TitleNote, Format, TitleType, Conference, Periodical, Series, Language, Volume, Issue, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Others, Position}, sepc );
 
    else
 
        tcommon = safejoin( {Title, TitleNote, Series, Format, TitleType, Conference, Periodical, Language, Volume, Issue, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Others, Position}, sepc );
 
    end
 
    -- DEBUG: tcommon = "/Title="..Title .. "/TitleType="..TitleType .. "/TitleNote="..TitleNote .. "/Format="..Format .. "/Edition="..Edition .. "/Language="..Language .. "/Conference="..Conference .. "/Periodical="..Periodical .. "/Series="..Series .. "/Volume="..Volume .. "/Issue="..Issue .. "/Position="..Position
 
  
    local idcommon = safejoin( { ARXIV, ASIN, BIBCODE, DOI, ISBN, ISSN, JFM, JSTOR, LCCN, MR, OCLC, OL, OSTI, PMC, PMID, RFC, SSRN, URL, ZBL, ID, Archived, AccessDate, Via, SubscriptionRequired, Lay, Quote, PostScript }, sepc );
+
This function never sets the flag to false but returns it's previous state because it may have been set by
    local enddot = "."
+
previous passes through this function or by the parameters |display-authors=etal or |display-editors=etal
    if (Quote ~= "") then enddot = "" end
 
    if ( config.CitationClass == "citation") then enddot = "" end
 
    idcommon = safejoin( { idcommon, enddot }, sepc )
 
  
    if ( config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) then
+
]]
        Chapter = Chapter
 
    end
 
  
    local text
+
local function name_has_etal (name, etal, nocat)
    local pgtext = Page .. Pages .. At
 
    if ( "" ~= Authors ) then
 
        if (Coauthors ~= "")
 
          then Authors = Authors .. "; " .. Coauthors
 
        end
 
        if ( "" ~= Date )
 
          then Date = " ("..Date..")" .. OrigYear .. sepc .. " "
 
          else
 
            if ( string.sub(Authors,-1,-1) == sepc) --check end character
 
              then Authors = Authors .. " "
 
              else Authors = Authors .. sepc .. " "
 
            end
 
        end
 
        if ( "" ~= Editors) then
 
            local in_text = " in "
 
            if (sepc == '.') then in_text = " In " end
 
            if (string.sub(Editors,-1,-1) == sepc)
 
                then Editors = in_text .. Editors .. " "
 
                else Editors = in_text .. Editors .. sepc .. " "
 
            end
 
        end
 
        text = safejoin( {Authors, Date, Chapter, Editors, tcommon }, sepc );
 
        text = safejoin( {text, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 
    elseif ( "" ~= Editors) then
 
        if ( "" ~= Date ) then
 
            if EditorCount <= 1 then
 
                Editors = Editors .. ", ed."
 
            else
 
                Editors = Editors .. ", eds."
 
            end               
 
            Date = " (" .. Date ..")" .. OrigYear .. sepc .. " "
 
        else
 
            if EditorCount <= 1 then
 
                Editors = Editors .. " (ed.)" .. sepc .. " "
 
            else
 
                Editors = Editors .. " (eds.)" .. sepc .. " "
 
            end               
 
        end
 
        text = safejoin( {Editors, Date, Chapter, tcommon}, sepc );
 
        text = safejoin( {text, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 
    else
 
        if ( "" ~= Date ) then
 
            if ( string.sub(tcommon,-1,-1) ~= sepc )
 
              then Date = sepc .." " .. Date
 
              else Date = " " .. Date
 
            end
 
        end -- endif ""~=Date
 
        text = safejoin( {Chapter, tcommon, Date}, sepc );
 
        text = safejoin( {text, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 
    end
 
   
 
    -- Now enclose the whole thing in a <span/> element
 
    if ( Year == nil ) then
 
        if ( DateIn ~= nil and DateIn ~= "" ) then
 
            Year = selectyear( DateIn )
 
        elseif( PublicationDate ~= nil and PublicationDate ~= "" ) then
 
            Year = selectyear( PublicationDate )
 
        else
 
            Year = ""
 
        end       
 
    end
 
    local classname = "citation"
 
    if ( config.CitationClass ~= "citation" )
 
      then classname = "citation " .. (config.CitationClass or "") end
 
    local args = { class=classname }
 
    if ( Ref ~= nil ) then
 
        local id = Ref
 
        if ( "harv" == Ref ) then
 
            local names = {} --table of last names & year
 
            if ( "" ~= Authors ) then
 
                for i,v in ipairs(a) do names[i] = v.last end
 
            elseif ( "" ~= Editors ) then
 
                for i,v in ipairs(e) do names[i] = v.last end
 
            end
 
            if ( names[1] == nil ) then
 
                names[1] = Year
 
            elseif ( names[2] == nil ) then
 
                names[2] = Year
 
            elseif ( names[3] == nil ) then
 
                names[3] = Year
 
            elseif ( names[4] == nil ) then
 
                names[4] = Year
 
            else
 
                names[5] = Year
 
            end
 
            id = anchorid(names)
 
        end
 
        args.id = id;
 
    end
 
   
 
    if string.len(text) < 2 then
 
        text = '<span class="error">Citation is empty</span>';
 
    end
 
   
 
    text = z.mw.text.tag({name="span", contents=text, params=args})
 
  
    local empty_span = z.mw.text.tag( {name="span", contents="&nbsp;", params={style="display: none;"}} );
+
if is_set (name) then -- name can be nil in which case just return
   
+
local etal_pattern = "[;,]? *[\"']*%f[%a][Ee][Tt] *[Aa][Ll][%.\"']*$" -- variations on the 'et al' theme
    -- Note: Using display: none on then COinS span breaks some clients.
+
local others_pattern = "[;,]? *%f[%a]and [Oo]thers"; -- and alternate to et al.
    local OCinS = z.mw.text.tag({name="span", contents=empty_span, params={class="Z3988",title=OCinStitle }})  
+
       
+
if name:match (etal_pattern) then -- variants on et al.
    return text .. OCinS
+
name = name:gsub (etal_pattern, ''); -- if found, remove
 +
etal = true; -- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
 +
if not nocat then -- no categorization for |vauthors=
 +
add_maint_cat ('etal'); -- and add a category if not already added
 +
end
 +
elseif name:match (others_pattern) then -- if not 'et al.', then 'and others'?
 +
name = name:gsub (others_pattern, ''); -- if found, remove
 +
etal = true; -- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
 +
if not nocat then -- no categorization for |vauthors=
 +
add_maint_cat ('etal'); -- and add a category if not already added
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
return name, etal; --
 
end
 
end
  
function r0(frame, name, group, page)
+
--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ M U L T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------
    if ( name == nil ) then return "" end
+
 
    if ( group == nil ) then group = "" end
+
Evaluates the content of author and editor (surnames only) parameters for multiple names.  Multiple names are
    local p = ""
+
indicated if there is more than one comma and or semicolon.  If found, the function adds the multiple name
    if ( page ~= nil ) then  
+
(author or editor) maintenance category.
        local contents = ":" .. page
+
 
        p = z.mw.text.tag({name="sup",contents=contents,params={class="reference",style="white-space:nowrap;"}})
+
]]
    end
+
 
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="ref",contents="",params={name=name,group=group}}, frame) .. p
+
local function name_has_mult_names (name, list_name)
 +
local count, _;
 +
if is_set (name) then
 +
if name:match ('^%(%(.*%)%)$') then -- if wrapped in doubled parentheses, ignore
 +
name = name:match ('^%(%((.*)%)%)$'); -- strip parens
 +
else
 +
_, count = name:gsub ('[;,]', ''); -- count the number of separator-like characters
 +
 +
if 1 < count then -- param could be |author= or |editor= so one separactor character is acceptable
 +
add_maint_cat ('mult_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]); -- more than one separator indicates multiple names so add a maint cat for this template
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
return name; -- and done
 
end
 
end
  
function reflist0(frame, config, args)
+
--[[--------------------------< E X T R A C T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------------------
    local contents = args.refs or ""
+
Gets name list from the input arguments
    local liststyle = args.liststyle
+
 
    local count = args[1]
+
Searches through args in sequential order to find |lastn= and |firstn= parameters (or their aliases), and their matching link and mask parameters.
    local width = args.colwidth
+
Stops searching when both |lastn= and |firstn= are not found in args after two sequential attempts: found |last1=, |last2=, and |last3= but doesn't
    local group = args.group or config.default_group
+
find |last4= and |last5= then the search is done.
    if ( nil == tonumber(count) and nil == width ) then
+
 
        width = count
+
This function emits an error message when there is a |firstn= without a matching |lastn=. When there are 'holes' in the list of last names, |last1= and |last3=
        count = nil
+
are present but |last2= is missing, an error message is emitted. |lastn= is not required to have a matching |firstn=.
    end
+
 
    if ( nil == liststyle ) then
+
When an author or editor parameter contains some form of 'et al.', the 'et al.' is stripped from the parameter and a flag (etal) returned
        if ( "upper-alpha" == group or "lower-alpha" == group or "upper-roman" == group or "lower-roman" == group or "upper-greek" == group or "lower-greek" == group ) then
+
that will cause list_people() to add the static 'et al.' text from Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration.  This keeps 'et al.' out of the
            liststyle = group
+
template's metadata.  When this occurs, the page is added to a maintenance category.
        else
+
 
            liststyle = config.default_liststyle
+
]]
        end
+
 
    end
+
local function extract_names(args, list_name)
    local params = {}
+
local names = {}; -- table of names
    params.class = "reflist"   
+
local last; -- individual name components
    params.style = z.wikitext.liststyle(liststyle)
+
local first;
    if ( nil ~= count ) then       
+
local link;
        params.class = params.class .. " references-column-count references-column-count-" .. count
+
local mask;
        params.style = params.style .. " " .. z.wikitext.columncountstyle(count)
+
local i = 1; -- loop counter/indexer
    end   
+
local n = 1; -- output table indexer
    if ( nil ~= width ) then
+
local count = 0; -- used to count the number of times we haven't found a |last= (or alias for authors, |editor-last or alias for editors)
        params.class = params.class .. " references-column-width"
+
local etal=false; -- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. in an author parameter
        params.style = params.style .. " " .. z.wikitext.columnwidthstyle(width)
+
 
    end
+
local err_msg_list_name = list_name:match ("(%w+)List") .. 's list'; -- modify AuthorList or EditorList for use in error messages if necessary
    local references = z.mw.text.tag({name="references",contents=contents,params={group=group}}, frame)
+
while true do
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="div",contents=references,params=params})
+
last = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', i ); -- search through args for name components beginning at 1
 +
first = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 +
link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 +
mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 +
 
 +
last, etal = name_has_etal (last, etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
 +
first, etal = name_has_etal (first, etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
 +
-- last = name_has_mult_names (last, err_msg_list_name); -- check for multiple names in last and its aliases
 +
last = name_has_mult_names (last, list_name); -- check for multiple names in last and its aliases
 +
 +
if first and not last then -- if there is a firstn without a matching lastn
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'first_missing_last', {err_msg_list_name, i}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
 +
elseif not first and not last then -- if both firstn and lastn aren't found, are we done?
 +
count = count + 1; -- number of times we haven't found last and first
 +
if 2 <= count then -- two missing names and we give up
 +
break; -- normal exit or there is a two-name hole in the list; can't tell which
 +
end
 +
else -- we have last with or without a first
 +
link_title_ok (link, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-link' .. i, last, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-last' .. i); -- check for improper wikimarkup
 +
 
 +
names[n] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=false}; -- add this name to our names list (corporate for |vauthors= only)
 +
n = n + 1; -- point to next location in the names table
 +
if 1 == count then -- if the previous name was missing
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'missing_name', {err_msg_list_name, i-1}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
 +
end
 +
count = 0; -- reset the counter, we're looking for two consecutive missing names
 +
end
 +
i = i + 1; -- point to next args location
 +
end
 +
 +
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names
 
end
 
end
  
function refbegin0(frame, config, args)
+
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ I S O 6 3 9 _ C O D E >------------------------------------------------
    local liststyle = args.liststyle
+
 
    local indent = args.indent
+
Validates language names provided in |language= parameter if not an ISO639-1 or 639-2 code.
    local indentsize = args.indentsize
+
 
    local count = args[1]
+
Returns the language name and associated two- or three-character code. Because case of the source may be incorrect
    local width = args.colwidth
+
or different from the case that WikiMedia uses, the name comparisons are done in lower case and when a match is
    if ( nil == tonumber(count) and nil == width ) then
+
found, the Wikimedia version (assumed to be correct) is returned along with the code. When there is no match, we
        width = count
+
return the original language name string.
        count = nil
+
 
    end
+
mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(<local wiki language>, 'all') return a list of languages that in some cases may include
    if ( nil == liststyle ) then
+
extensions. For example, code 'cbk-zam' and its associated name 'Chavacano de Zamboanga' (MediaWiki does not support
        if ( "upper-alpha" == group or "lower-alpha" == group or "upper-roman" == group or "lower-roman" == group or "upper-greek" == group or "lower-greek" == group ) then
+
code 'cbk' or name 'Chavacano'.
            liststyle = group
+
 
        else
+
Names but that are included in the list will be found if that name is provided in the |language= parameter.  For example,
            liststyle = config.default_liststyle
+
if |language=Chavacano de Zamboanga, that name will be found with the associated code 'cbk-zam'.  When names are found
        end
+
and the associated code is not two or three characters, this function returns only the Wikimedia language name.
    end
+
 
    local params = {}
+
Adapted from code taken from Module:Check ISO 639-1.
    params.class = "refbegin"
+
 
    params.style = z.wikitext.liststyle(liststyle)
+
]]
    if ( nil ~= count ) then       
+
 
        params.class = params.class .. " references-column-count references-column-count-" .. count
+
local function get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code)
        params.style = params.style .. " " .. z.wikitext.columncountstyle(count)
+
local languages = mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(this_wiki_code, 'all') -- get a list of language names known to Wikimedia
    end   
+
-- ('all' is required for North Ndebele, South Ndebele, and Ojibwa)
    if ( nil ~= width ) then
+
local langlc = mw.ustring.lower(lang); -- lower case version for comparisons
        params.class = params.class .. " references-column-width"
+
        params.style = params.style .. " " .. z.wikitext.columnwidthstyle(width)
+
for code, name in pairs(languages) do -- scan the list to see if we can find our language
    end
+
if langlc == mw.ustring.lower(name) then
    local dlopen
+
if 2 ~= code:len() and 3 ~= code:len() then -- two- or three-character codes only; extensions not supported
    if ( nil ~= indent ) then
+
return name; -- so return the name but not the code
        dlopen = z.wikitext.OpenHTMLTag({name="dl",params={style="text-indent: -" .. (indentsize or "3.2") .. "em;"}})
+
end
    else
+
return name, code; -- found it, return name to ensure proper capitalization and the the code
        dlopen = ""
+
end
    end
+
end
    return z.wikitext.OpenHTMLTag({name="div",params=params}) .. dlopen
+
return lang; -- not valid language; return language in original case and nil for the code
 
end
 
end
  
function refend0(frame, config, args)
+
--[[--------------------------< L A N G U A G E _ P A R A M E T E R >------------------------------------------
    local indent = args.indent
+
 
    local dlclose
+
Gets language name from a provided two- or three-character ISO 639 code.  If a code is recognized by MediaWiki,
    if ( nil ~= indent ) then
+
use the returned name; if not, then use the value that was provided with the language parameter.
        dlclose = "</dl>"
+
 
    else
+
When |language= contains a recognized language (either code or name), the page is assigned to the category for
        dlclose = ""
+
that code: Category:Norwegian-language sources (no).  For valid three-character code languages, the page is assigned
    end
+
to the single category for '639-2' codes: Category:CS1 ISO 639-2 language sources.
    return dlclose .. "</div>"
+
 
 +
Languages that are the same as the local wiki are not categorized.  MediaWiki does not recognize three-character
 +
equivalents of two-character codes: code 'ar' is recognized bit code 'ara' is not.
 +
 
 +
This function supports multiple languages in the form |language=nb, French, th where the language names or codes are
 +
separated from each other by commas.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function language_parameter (lang)
 +
local code; -- the two- or three-character language code
 +
local name; -- the language name
 +
local language_list = {}; -- table of language names to be rendered
 +
local names_table = {}; -- table made from the value assigned to |language=
 +
 
 +
local this_wiki = mw.getContentLanguage(); -- get a language object for this wiki
 +
local this_wiki_code = this_wiki:getCode() -- get this wiki's language code
 +
local this_wiki_name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName(this_wiki_code, this_wiki_code); -- get this wiki's language name
 +
 
 +
names_table = mw.text.split (lang, '%s*,%s*'); -- names should be a comma separated list
 +
 
 +
for _, lang in ipairs (names_table) do -- reuse lang
 +
 
 +
if lang:match ('^%a%a%-') then -- strip ietf language tags from code; TODO: is there a need to support 3-char with tag?
 +
lang = lang:match ('(%a%a)%-') -- keep only 639-1 code portion to lang; TODO: do something with 3166 alpha 2 country code?
 +
end
 +
if 2 == lang:len() or 3 == lang:len() then -- if two-or three-character code
 +
name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang:lower(), this_wiki_code); -- get language name if |language= is a proper code
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set (name) then -- if |language= specified a valid code
 +
code = lang:lower(); -- save it
 +
else
 +
name, code = get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code); -- attempt to get code from name (assign name here so that we are sure of proper capitalization)
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set (code) then -- only 2- or 3-character codes
 +
if this_wiki_code ~= code then -- when the language is not the same as this wiki's language
 +
if 2 == code:len() then -- and is a two-character code
 +
add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source', {name, code}) -- categorize it
 +
else -- or is a recognized language (but has a three-character code)
 +
add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source_2', {code}) -- categorize it differently TODO: support mutliple three-character code categories per cs1|2 template
 +
end
 +
end
 +
else
 +
add_maint_cat ('unknown_lang'); -- add maint category if not already added
 +
end
 +
 +
table.insert (language_list, name);
 +
name = ''; -- so we can reuse it
 +
end
 +
 +
code = #language_list -- reuse code as number of languages in the list
 +
if 2 >= code then
 +
name = table.concat (language_list, ' and ') -- insert '<space>and<space>' between two language names
 +
elseif 2 < code then
 +
language_list[code] = 'and ' .. language_list[code]; -- prepend last name with 'and<space>'
 +
name = table.concat (language_list, ', ') -- and concatenate with '<comma><space>' separators
 +
end
 +
if this_wiki_name == name then
 +
return ''; -- if one language and that language is this wiki's return an empty string (no annotation)
 +
end
 +
return (" " .. wrap_msg ('language', name)); -- otherwise wrap with '(in ...)'
 +
--[[ TODO: should only return blank or name rather than full list
 +
so we can clean up the bunched parenthetical elements Language, Type, Format
 +
]]
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by {{doi}} to create DOI links in the style used in citations.
+
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 1 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------
function z.doi(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
Set style settings for CS1 citation templates. Returns separator and postscript settings
    local id = pframe.args.id or pframe.args[1] or ""
+
 
    return doi(frame, id)
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local function set_cs1_style (ps)
 +
if not is_set (ps) then -- unless explicitely set to something
 +
ps = '.'; -- terminate the rendered citation with a period
 +
end
 +
return '.', ps; -- separator is a full stop
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by {{ISSN}} to create ISSN links in the style used in citations.
+
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 2 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------
function z.ISSN(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
Set style settings for CS2 citation templates. Returns separator, postscript, ref settings
    local Name = pframe.args[1] or ""
+
 
    return hideinprint(frame, "[[International Standard Serial Number|ISSN]]&nbsp;[http://www.worldcat.org/search?fq=x0:jrnl&q=n2:" .. Name .. " " .. Name .. "]")
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local function set_cs2_style (ps, ref)
 +
if not is_set (ps) then -- if |postscript= has not been set, set cs2 default
 +
ps = ''; -- make sure it isn't nil
 +
end
 +
if not is_set (ref) then -- if |ref= is not set
 +
ref = "harv"; -- set default |ref=harv
 +
end
 +
return ',', ps, ref; -- separator is a comma
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by templates such as {{SfnRef}} to create the (encoded) anchor name for a Harvard cross-reference hyperlink.
+
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ S E T T I N G S _ F R O M _ C I T E _ C L A S S >----------------------
function z.SFNID(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
When |mode= is not set or when its value is invalid, use config.CitationClass and parameter values to establish
    return anchorid(pframe.args)
+
rendered style.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class)
 +
local sep;
 +
if (cite_class == "citation") then -- for citation templates (CS2)
 +
sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
 +
else -- not a citation template so CS1
 +
sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
 +
end
 +
 
 +
return sep, ps, ref -- return them all
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by templates such as {{Harvard citation}} to create the Harvard cross-reference text.
+
--[[--------------------------< S E T _ S T Y L E >------------------------------------------------------------
function z.Harvard(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
Establish basic style settings to be used when rendering the citation.  Uses |mode= if set and valid or uses
    return crossref(frame, pframe.args)
+
config.CitationClass from the template's #invoke: to establish style.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function set_style (mode, ps, ref, cite_class)
 +
local sep;
 +
if 'cs2' == mode then -- if this template is to be rendered in CS2 (citation) style
 +
sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
 +
elseif 'cs1' == mode then -- if this template is to be rendered in CS1 (cite xxx) style
 +
sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
 +
elseif 'mla' == mode then -- if this template is to be rendered in mla style use cs1 for bot cs1 & cs2 templates
 +
sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
 +
else -- anything but cs1 or cs2
 +
sep, ps, ref = get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class); -- get settings based on the template's CitationClass
 +
end
 +
if 'none' == ps:lower() then -- if assigned value is 'none' then
 +
ps = ''; -- set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 +
return sep, ps, ref
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P D F >------------------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Determines if a url has the file extension that is one of the pdf file extensions used by [[MediaWiki:Common.css]] when
 +
applying the pdf icon to external links.
 +
 
 +
returns true if file extension is one of the recognized extension, else false
 +
 
 +
]=]
 +
 
 +
local function is_pdf (url)
 +
return url:match ('%.pdf[%?#]?') or url:match ('%.PDF[%?#]?');
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< S T Y L E _ F O R M A T >------------------------------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Applies css style to |format=, |chapter-format=, etc.  Also emits an error message if the format parameter does
 +
not have a matching url parameter.  If the format parameter is not set and the url contains a file extension that
 +
is recognized as a pdf document by MediaWiki's commons.css, this code will set the format parameter to (PDF) with
 +
the appropriate styling.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function style_format (format, url, fmt_param, url_param)
 +
if is_set (format) then
 +
format = wrap_style ('format', format); -- add leading space, parenthases, resize
 +
if not is_set (url) then
 +
format = format .. set_error( 'format_missing_url', {fmt_param, url_param} ); -- add an error message
 +
end
 +
elseif is_pdf (url) then -- format is not set so if url is a pdf file then
 +
format = wrap_style ('format', 'PDF'); -- set format to pdf
 +
else
 +
format = ''; -- empty string for concatenation
 +
end
 +
return format;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ D I S P L A Y _ A U T H O R S _ E D I T O R S >------------------------
 +
 
 +
Returns a number that defines the number of names displayed for author and editor name lists and a boolean flag
 +
to indicate when et al. should be appended to the name list.
 +
 
 +
When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is a number greater than or equal to zero, return the number and
 +
the previous state of the 'etal' flag (false by default but may have been set to true if the name list contains
 +
some variant of the text 'et al.').
 +
 
 +
When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is the keyword 'etal', return a number that is one greater than the
 +
number of authors in the list and set the 'etal' flag true.  This will cause the list_people() to display all of
 +
the names in the name list followed by 'et al.'
 +
 
 +
In all other cases, returns nil and the previous state of the 'etal' flag.
 +
 
 +
inputs:
 +
max: A['DisplayAuthors'] or A['DisplayEditors']; a number or some flavor of etal
 +
count: #a or #e
 +
list_name: 'authors' or 'editors'
 +
etal: author_etal or editor_etal
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function get_display_authors_editors (max, count, list_name, etal)
 +
if is_set (max) then
 +
if 'etal' == max:lower():gsub("[ '%.]", '') then -- the :gsub() portion makes 'etal' from a variety of 'et al.' spellings and stylings
 +
max = count + 1; -- number of authors + 1 so display all author name plus et al.
 +
etal = true; -- overrides value set by extract_names()
 +
elseif max:match ('^%d+$') then -- if is a string of numbers
 +
max = tonumber (max); -- make it a number
 +
if max >= count then -- if |display-xxxxors= value greater than or equal to number of authors/editors
 +
add_maint_cat ('disp_auth_ed', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]);
 +
end
 +
else -- not a valid keyword or number
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {'display-' .. list_name, max}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
max = nil; -- unset; as if |display-xxxxors= had not been set
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
return max, etal;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< E X T R A _ T E X T _ I N _ P A G E _ C H E C K >------------------------------
 +
 
 +
Adds page to Category:CS1 maint: extra text if |page= or |pages= has what appears to be some form of p. or pp.
 +
abbreviation in the first characters of the parameter content.
 +
 
 +
check Page and Pages for extraneous p, p., pp, and pp. at start of parameter value:
 +
good pattern: '^P[^%.P%l]' matches when |page(s)= begins PX or P# but not Px where x and X are letters and # is a dgiit
 +
bad pattern: '^[Pp][Pp]' matches matches when |page(s)= begins pp or pP or Pp or PP
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function extra_text_in_page_check (page)
 +
-- local good_pattern = '^P[^%.P%l]';
 +
local good_pattern = '^P[^%.Pp]'; -- ok to begin with uppercase P: P7 (pg 7 of section P) but not p123 (page 123) TODO: add Gg for PG or Pg?
 +
-- local bad_pattern = '^[Pp][Pp]';
 +
local bad_pattern = '^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]';
 +
 
 +
if not page:match (good_pattern) and (page:match (bad_pattern) or  page:match ('^[Pp]ages?')) then
 +
add_maint_cat ('extra_text');
 +
end
 +
-- if Page:match ('^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]') or  Page:match ('^[Pp]ages?[ %d]') or
 +
-- Pages:match ('^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]') or  Pages:match ('^[Pp]ages?[ %d]') then
 +
-- add_maint_cat ('extra_text');
 +
-- end
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by templates such as {{cite book}} to create the actual citation text.
+
--[[--------------------------< G E T _ V _ N A M E _ T A B L E >----------------------------------------------
function z.citation(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
split apart a |vautthors= or |veditors= parameter.  This function allows for corporate names, wrapped in doubled
   
+
parentheses to also have commas; in the old version of the code, the doubled parnetheses were included in the
    local args = {};
+
rendered citation and in the metadata.
    for k, v in pairs( pframe.args ) do
+
 
        args[k] = v;
+
|vauthors=Jones AB, White EB, ((Black, Brown, and Co.))
    end  
+
 
    return citation0(frame, args)
+
This code is experimental and may not be retained.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
local function get_v_name_table (vparam, output_table)
 +
local name_table = mw.text.split(vparam, "%s*,%s*"); -- names are separated by commas
 +
 +
local i = 1;
 +
 +
while name_table[i] do
 +
if name_table[i]:match ('^%(%(.*[^%)][^%)]$') then -- first segment of corporate with one or more commas; this segment has the opening doubled parens
 +
local name = name_table[i];
 +
i=i+1; -- bump indexer to next segment
 +
while name_table[i] do
 +
name = name .. ', ' .. name_table[i]; -- concatenate with previous segments
 +
if name_table[i]:match ('^.*%)%)$') then -- if this table member has the closing doubled parens
 +
break; -- and done reassembling so
 +
end
 +
i=i+1; -- bump indexer
 +
end
 +
table.insert (output_table, name); -- and add corporate name to the output table
 +
else
 +
table.insert (output_table, name_table[i]); -- add this name
 +
end
 +
i = i+1;
 +
end
 +
return output_table;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< P A R S E _ V A U T H O R S _ V E D I T O R S >--------------------------------
 +
 
 +
This function extracts author / editor names from |vauthors= or |veditors= and finds matching |xxxxor-maskn= and
 +
|xxxxor-linkn= in args.  It then returns a table of assembled names just as extract_names() does.
 +
 
 +
Author / editor names in |vauthors= or |veditors= must be in Vancouver system style. Corporate or institutional names
 +
may sometimes be required and because such names will often fail the is_good_vanc_name() and other format compliance
 +
tests, are wrapped in doubled paranethese ((corporate name)) to suppress the format tests.
 +
 
 +
Supports generational suffixes Jr, 2nd, 3rd, 4th–6th.
 +
 
 +
This function sets the vancouver error when a reqired comma is missing and when there is a space between an author's initials.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function parse_vauthors_veditors (args, vparam, list_name)
 +
local names = {}; -- table of names assembled from |vauthors=, |author-maskn=, |author-linkn=
 +
local v_name_table = {};
 +
local etal = false; -- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. vauthors parameter
 +
local last, first, link, mask, suffix;
 +
local corporate = false;
 +
 
 +
vparam, etal = name_has_etal (vparam, etal, true); -- find and remove variations on et al. do not categorize (do it here because et al. might have a period)
 +
if vparam:find ('%[%[') or vparam:find ('%]%]') then -- no wikilinking vauthors names
 +
add_vanc_error ('wikilink');
 +
end
 +
v_name_table = get_v_name_table (vparam, v_name_table); -- names are separated by commas
 +
 
 +
for i, v_name in ipairs(v_name_table) do
 +
if v_name:match ('^%(%(.+%)%)$') then -- corporate authors are wrapped in doubled parentheses to supress vanc formatting and error detection
 +
first = ''; -- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
 +
last = v_name:match ('^%(%((.+)%)%)$') -- remove doubled parntheses
 +
corporate = true; -- flag used in list_people()
 +
elseif string.find(v_name, "%s") then
 +
if v_name:find('[;%.]') then -- look for commonly occurring punctuation characters;
 +
add_vanc_error ('punctuation');
 +
end
 +
local lastfirstTable = {}
 +
lastfirstTable = mw.text.split(v_name, "%s")
 +
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- removes and returns value of last element in table which should be author intials
 +
if is_suffix (first) then -- if a valid suffix
 +
suffix = first -- save it as a suffix and
 +
first = table.remove(lastfirstTable); -- get what should be the initials from the table
 +
end -- no suffix error message here because letter combination may be result of Romanization; check for digits?
 +
last = table.concat(lastfirstTable, " ") -- returns a string that is the concatenation of all other names that are not initials
 +
if mw.ustring.match (last, '%a+%s+%u+%s+%a+') then
 +
add_vanc_error ('missing comma'); -- matches last II last; the case when a comma is missing
 +
end
 +
if mw.ustring.match (v_name, ' %u %u$') then -- this test is in the wrong place TODO: move or replace with a more appropriate test
 +
add_vanc_error ('name'); -- matches a space between two intiials
 +
end
 +
else
 +
first = ''; -- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
 +
last = v_name; -- last name or single corporate name?  Doesn't support multiword corporate names? do we need this?
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set (first) then
 +
if not mw.ustring.match (first, "^%u?%u$") then -- first shall contain one or two upper-case letters, nothing else
 +
add_vanc_error ('initials'); -- too many initials; mixed case initials (which may be ok Romanization); hyphenated initials
 +
end
 +
is_good_vanc_name (last, first); -- check first and last before restoring the suffix which may have a non-Latin digit
 +
if is_set (suffix) then
 +
first = first .. ' ' .. suffix; -- if there was a suffix concatenate with the initials
 +
suffix = ''; -- unset so we don't add this suffix to all subsequent names
 +
end
 +
else
 +
if not corporate then
 +
is_good_vanc_name (last, '');
 +
end
 +
end
 +
-- this from extract_names ()
 +
link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 +
mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
 +
names[i] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=corporate}; -- add this assembled name to our names list
 +
end
 +
return names, etal; -- all done, return our list of names
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< S E L E C T _ A U T H O R _ E D I T O R _ S O U R C E >------------------------
 +
 
 +
Select one of |authors=, |authorn= / |lastn / firstn=, or |vauthors= as the source of the author name list or
 +
select one of |editors=, |editorn= / editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= or |veditors= as the source of the editor name list.
 +
 
 +
Only one of these appropriate three will be used.  The hierarchy is: |authorn= (and aliases) highest and |authors= lowest and
 +
similarly, |editorn= (and aliases) highest and |editors= lowest
 +
 
 +
When looking for |authorn= / |editorn= parameters, test |xxxxor1= and |xxxxor2= (and all of their aliases); stops after the second
 +
test which mimicks the test used in extract_names() when looking for a hole in the author name list. There may be a better
 +
way to do this, I just haven't discovered what that way is.
 +
 
 +
Emits an error message when more than one xxxxor name source is provided.
 +
 
 +
In this function, vxxxxors = vauthors or veditors; xxxxors = authors or editors as appropriate.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function select_author_editor_source (vxxxxors, xxxxors, args, list_name)
 +
local lastfirst = false;
 +
if select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 1 ) or -- do this twice incase we have a |first1= without a |last1=; this ...
 +
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 1 ) or -- ... also catches the case where |first= is used with |vauthors=
 +
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 2 ) or
 +
select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 2 ) then
 +
lastfirst=true;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if (is_set (vxxxxors) and true == lastfirst) or -- these are the three error conditions
 +
(is_set (vxxxxors) and is_set (xxxxors)) or
 +
(true == lastfirst and is_set (xxxxors)) then
 +
local err_name;
 +
if 'AuthorList' == list_name then -- figure out which name should be used in error message
 +
err_name = 'author';
 +
else
 +
err_name = 'editor';
 +
end
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters',
 +
{err_name .. '-name-list parameters'}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if true == lastfirst then return 1 end; -- return a number indicating which author name source to use
 +
if is_set (vxxxxors) then return 2 end;
 +
if is_set (xxxxors) then return 3 end;
 +
return 1; -- no authors so return 1; this allows missing author name test to run in case there is a first without last
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
--[[--------------------------< I S _ V A L I D _ P A R A M E T E R _ V A L U E >------------------------------
 +
 
 +
This function is used to validate a parameter's assigned value for those parameters that have only a limited number
 +
of allowable values (yes, y, true, no, etc).  When the parameter value has not been assigned a value (missing or empty
 +
in the source template) the function refurns true.  If the parameter value is one of the list of allowed values returns
 +
true; else, emits an error message and returns false.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function is_valid_parameter_value (value, name, possible, cite_class)
 +
-- begin hack to limit |mode=mla to a specific set of templates
 +
if ('mode' == name) and ('mla' == value) and not in_array (cite_class, {'book', 'journal', 'news'}) then
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {name, value}, true ) } ); -- not an allowed value so add error message
 +
return false
 +
end
 +
-- end hack
 +
 
 +
if not is_set (value) then
 +
return true; -- an empty parameter is ok
 +
elseif in_array(value:lower(), possible) then
 +
return true;
 +
else
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {name, value}, true ) } ); -- not an allowed value so add error message
 +
return false
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by templates such as {{sfn}} to create the entire cross-reference.
+
 
function z.sfn(frame)
+
--[[--------------------------< T E R M I N A T E _ N A M E _ L I S T >----------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local content = crossref(frame, pframe.args)
+
This function terminates a name list (author, contributor, editor) with a separator character (sepc) and a space
    local args = { name = refid(pframe.args) }
+
when the last character is not a sepc character or when the last three characters are not sepc followed by two
    return z.mw.text.tag({name = "ref", contents = content, params = args}, frame)
+
closing square brackets (close of a wikilink).  When either of these is true, the name_list is terminated with a
 +
single space character.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function terminate_name_list (name_list, sepc)
 +
if (string.sub (name_list,-1,-1) == sepc) or (string.sub (name_list,-3,-1) == sepc .. ']]') then -- if last name in list ends with sepc char
 +
return name_list .. " "; -- don't add another
 +
else
 +
return name_list .. sepc .. ' '; -- otherwise terninate the name list
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by template {{r}}.
+
 
function z.r(frame)
+
--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ V O L U M E _ I S S U E >----------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
returns the concatenation of the formatted volume and issue parameters as a single string; or formatted volume
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
or formatted issue, or an empty string if neither are set.
    args.page1 = args.page1 or args.page
+
 
    local text = ""
+
]]
    -- This would be shorter using ipairs(), but that doesn't work on an arguments table supplied to a template.
+
    local index = 1
+
local function format_volume_issue (volume, issue, cite_class, origin, sepc, lower, mode)
    while args[index] ~= nil do
+
if not is_set (volume) and not is_set (issue) then
        local arg = args[index]
+
return '';
        local t = r0(frame, arg, args.group, args["page" .. index])
+
end
        text = text .. t
+
        index = index + 1
+
if ('mla' == mode) and ('journal' == cite_class) then -- same as cs1 for magazines
    end
+
lower = true; -- mla 8th edition; force these to lower case
    return text
+
if is_set (volume) and is_set (issue) then
 +
return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, volume, issue}, lower);
 +
elseif is_set (volume) then
 +
return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, volume}, lower);
 +
else
 +
return '';
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if 'magazine' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map'}) and 'magazine' == origin) then
 +
if is_set (volume) and is_set (issue) then
 +
return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, volume, issue}, lower);
 +
elseif is_set (volume) then
 +
return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, volume}, lower);
 +
else
 +
return wrap_msg ('issue', {sepc, issue}, lower);
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local vol = '';
 +
 +
if is_set (volume) then
 +
if (4 < mw.ustring.len(volume)) then
 +
vol = substitute (cfg.messages['j-vol'], {sepc, volume});
 +
else
 +
vol = substitute (cfg.presentation['vol-bold'], {sepc, hyphen_to_dash(volume)});
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set (issue) then
 +
return vol .. substitute (cfg.messages['j-issue'], issue);
 +
end
 +
return vol;
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by template {{ref label}}.
+
 
function z.reflabel(frame)
+
--[[-------------------------< N O R M A L I Z E _ P A G E _ L I S T >-----------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
not currently used
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
 
    local P1 = args[1] or ""
+
normalizes a comma, ampersand, and/or space separated list to be '<value>, <value>, ..., <value>'
    local P2 = args[2] or ""
+
returns list unchanged if there are no commas else strips whitespace and then reformats the list
    local P3 = args[3] or ""
+
 
    local id = nil
+
]]
    local contents = "[[#endnote_" .. P1 .. P3 .. "|&#91;" .. P2 .. "&#93;]]"
+
--[[
    local params = {}
+
local function normalize_page_list (list)
    params.class="reference"
+
if not list:find ('[,& ]') then return list end -- if list is not delimited with commas, ampersands, or spaces; done
    if ( args.noid == nil or args.noid == "" ) then params.id = "ref_" .. P1 .. P3 end
+
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="sup",contents=contents,params=params})
+
list = mw.text.split (list, '[,&%s]+'); -- make a table of values
 +
list = table.concat (list, ', '); -- and now make a normalized list
 +
return list;
 
end
 
end
 +
]]
 +
 +
 +
--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ P A G E S _ S H E E T S >-----------------------------------------
 +
 +
adds static text to one of |page(s)= or |sheet(s)= values and returns it with all of the others set to empty strings.
 +
The return order is:
 +
page, pages, sheet, sheets
 +
 +
Singular has priority over plural when both are provided.
 +
 +
]]
 +
 +
local function format_pages_sheets (page, pages, sheet, sheets, cite_class, origin, sepc, nopp, lower, mode)
 +
if 'map' == cite_class then -- only cite map supports sheet(s) as in-source locators
 +
if is_set (sheet) then
 +
if 'journal' == origin then
 +
return '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheet', sheet, lower), '';
 +
else
 +
return '', '', wrap_msg ('sheet', {sepc, sheet}, lower), '';
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set (sheets) then
 +
if 'journal' == origin then
 +
return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheets', sheets, lower);
 +
else
 +
return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('sheets', {sepc, sheets}, lower);
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
local is_journal = 'journal' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map'}) and 'journal' == origin);
 +
 +
if is_journal and 'mla' == mode then
 +
is_journal = false; -- mla always uses p & pp
 +
end
  
-- This is used by template {{note label}}.
+
if is_set (page) then
function z.notelabel(frame)
+
if is_journal then
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], page), '', '', '';
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
elseif not nopp then
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
return substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
    local id = args[1] or ""
+
else
    local arrow = args[3] or ""
+
return substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
    local postscript = args[4] or ""
+
end
    local contents
+
elseif is_set(pages) then
    if arrow ~= "" then
+
if is_journal then
        local sup_arrow = z.mw.text.tag({name="sup",contents=arrow,params={}})
+
return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], pages), '', '', '';
        contents = "[[#ref_" .. id .. arrow .. "|<b>" .. sup_arrow .. "</b>]]" .. postscript
+
elseif tonumber(pages) ~= nil and not nopp then -- if pages is only digits, assume a single page number
        if "none" == arrow then arrow = "^" end -- Change this AFTER using it in the ID parameter and the contents.
+
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
    else
+
elseif not nopp then
        contents = (args[2] or "") .. postscript
+
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['pp-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
    end
+
else
    local params = { class="citation wikicite" }
+
return '', substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
    if id ~= "" and ( args.noid == nil or args.noid == "" ) then
+
end
        params.id = mw.uri.anchorEncode("endnote_" .. id .. arrow)
+
end
    end
+
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="span",contents=contents,params=params})
+
return '', '', '', ''; -- return empty strings
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by templates {{reflist}} and {{notelist}}.
+
 
function z.reflist(frame)
+
--[=[-------------------------< A R C H I V E _ U R L _ C H E C K >--------------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
Check archive.org urls to make sure they at least look like they are pointing at valid archives and not to the
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
save snapshot url or to calendar pages.  When the archive url is 'https://web.archive.org/save/' (or http://...)
    return reflist0(frame, config, args)
+
archive.org saves a snapshot of the target page in the url.  That is something that Wikipedia should not allow
 +
unwitting readers to do.
 +
 
 +
When the archive.org url does not have a complete timestamp, archive.org chooses a snapshot according to its own
 +
algorithm or provides a calendar 'search' result.  [[WP:ELNO]] discourages links to search results.
 +
 
 +
This function looks at the value assigned to |archive-url= and returns empty strings for |archive-url= and
 +
|archive-date= and an error message when:
 +
|archive-url= holds an archive.org save command url
 +
|archive-url= is an archive.org url that does not have a complete timestamp (YYYYMMDDhhmmss 14 digits) in the
 +
correct place
 +
otherwise returns |archive-url= and |archive-date=
 +
 
 +
There are two mostly compatible archive.org urls:
 +
//web.archive.org/<timestamp>... -- the old form
 +
//web.archive.org/web/<timestamp>... -- the new form
 +
 
 +
The old form does not support or map to the new form when it contains a display flag.  There are four identified flags
 +
('id_', 'js_', 'cs_', 'im_') but since archive.org ignores others following the same form (two letters and an underscore)
 +
we don't check for these specific flags but we do check the form.
 +
 
 +
This function supports a preview mode. When the article is rendered in preview mode, this funct may return a modified
 +
archive url:
 +
for save command errors, return undated wildcard (/*/)
 +
for timestamp errors when the timestamp has a wildcard, return the url unmodified
 +
for timestamp errors when the timestamp does not have a wildcard, return with timestamp limited to six digits plus wildcard (/yyyymm*/)
 +
 
 +
]=]
 +
 
 +
local function archive_url_check (url, date)
 +
local err_msg = ''; -- start with the error message empty
 +
local path, timestamp, flag; -- portions of the archive.or url
 +
 +
if not url:match('//web%.archive%.org/') then
 +
return url, date; -- not an archive.org archive, return ArchiveURL and ArchiveDate
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if url:match('//web%.archive%.org/save/') then -- if a save command url, we don't want to allow saving of the target page
 +
err_msg = 'save command';
 +
url = url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org)/save/', '%1/*/', 1); -- for preview mode: modify ArchiveURL
 +
else
 +
path, timestamp, flag = url:match('//web%.archive%.org/([^%d]*)(%d+)([^/]*)/'); -- split out some of the url parts for evaluation
 +
 +
if not is_set(timestamp) or 14 ~= timestamp:len() then -- path and flag optional, must have 14-digit timestamp here
 +
err_msg = 'timestamp';
 +
if '*' ~= flag then
 +
url=url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org/[^%d]*%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?)[^/]*', '%1*', 1) -- for preview, modify ts to be yearmo* max (0-6 digits plus splat)
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set(path) and 'web/' ~= path then -- older archive urls do not have the extra 'web/' path element
 +
err_msg = 'path';
 +
elseif is_set (flag) and not is_set (path) then -- flag not allowed with the old form url (without the 'web/' path element)
 +
err_msg = 'flag';
 +
elseif is_set (flag) and not flag:match ('%a%a_') then -- flag if present must be two alpha characters and underscore (requires 'web/' path element)
 +
err_msg = 'flag';
 +
else
 +
return url, date; -- return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
 +
end
 +
end
 +
-- if here, something not right so
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'archive_url', {err_msg}, true ) } ); -- add error message and
 +
if is_set (Frame:preprocess('{{REVISIONID}}')) then
 +
return '', ''; -- return empty strings for archiveURL and ArchiveDate
 +
else
 +
return url, date; -- preview mode so return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by template {{refbegin}}.
+
 
function z.refbegin(frame)
+
--[[--------------------------< M I S S I N G _ P I P E _ C H E C K >------------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
Look at the contents of a parameter. If the content has a string of characters and digits followed by an equal
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
sign, compare the alphanumeric string to the list of cs1|2 parameters.  If found, then the string is possibly a
    return refbegin0(frame, config, args)
+
parameter that is missing its pipe:
 +
{{cite ... |title=Title access-date=2016-03-17}}
 +
 
 +
cs1|2 shares some parameter names with xml/html atributes: class=, title=, etc.  To prevent false positives xml/html
 +
tags are removed before the search.
 +
 
 +
If a missing pipe is detected, this function adds the missing pipe maintenance category.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local function missing_pipe_check (value)
 +
local capture;
 +
value = value:gsub ('%b<>', ''); -- remove xml/html tags because attributes: class=, title=, etc
 +
 
 +
capture = value:match ('%s+(%a[%a%d]+)%s*=') or value:match ('^(%a[%a%d]+)%s*='); -- find and categorize parameters with possible missing pipes
 +
if capture and validate (capture) then -- if the capture is a valid parameter name
 +
add_maint_cat ('missing_pipe');
 +
end
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by template {{refend}}.
+
 
function z.refend(frame)
+
--[[--------------------------< C I T A T I O N 0 >------------------------------------------------------------
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
 
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
This is the main function doing the majority of the citation formatting.
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
 
    return refend0(frame, config, args)
+
]]
 +
 
 +
local function citation0( config, args)
 +
--[[
 +
Load Input Parameters
 +
The argument_wrapper facilitates the mapping of multiple aliases to single internal variable.
 +
]]
 +
local A = argument_wrapper( args );
 +
local i
 +
 
 +
-- Pick out the relevant fields from the arguments.  Different citation templates
 +
-- define different field names for the same underlying things.
 +
 
 +
-- set default parameter values defined by |mode= parameter.  If |mode= is empty or omitted, use CitationClass to set these values
 +
local Mode = A['Mode'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (Mode, 'mode', cfg.keywords['mode'], config.CitationClass) then
 +
Mode = '';
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local author_etal;
 +
local a = {}; -- authors list from |lastn= / |firstn= pairs or |vauthors=
 +
local Authors;
 +
local NameListFormat = A['NameListFormat'];
 +
local Collaboration = A['Collaboration'];
 +
 
 +
do -- to limit scope of selected
 +
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Vauthors'], A['Authors'], args, 'AuthorList');
 +
if 1 == selected then
 +
a, author_etal = extract_names (args, 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |authorn= / |lastn= / |firstn=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
 +
elseif 2 == selected then
 +
NameListFormat = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
 +
a, author_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.vauthors, 'AuthorList'); -- fetch author list from |vauthors=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
 +
elseif 3 == selected then
 +
Authors = A['Authors']; -- use content of |authors=
 +
if 'authors' == A:ORIGIN('Authors') then -- but add a maint cat if the parameter is |authors=
 +
add_maint_cat ('authors'); -- because use of this parameter is discouraged; what to do about the aliases is a TODO:
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set (Collaboration) then
 +
author_etal = true; -- so that |display-authors=etal not required
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local Coauthors = A['Coauthors'];
 +
local Others = A['Others'];
 +
 
 +
local editor_etal;
 +
local e = {}; -- editors list from |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= pairs or |veditors=
 +
local Editors;
 +
 
 +
do -- to limit scope of selected
 +
local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Veditors'], A['Editors'], args, 'EditorList');
 +
if 1 == selected then
 +
e, editor_etal = extract_names (args, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |editorn= / |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
 +
elseif 2 == selected then
 +
NameListFormat = 'vanc'; -- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
 +
e, editor_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.veditors, 'EditorList'); -- fetch editor list from |veditors=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
 +
elseif 3 == selected then
 +
Editors = A['Editors']; -- use content of |editors=
 +
add_maint_cat ('editors'); -- but add a maint cat because use of this parameter is discouraged
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local t = {}; -- translators list from |translator-lastn= / translator-firstn= pairs
 +
local Translators; -- assembled translators name list
 +
t = extract_names (args, 'TranslatorList'); -- fetch translator list from |translatorn= / |translator-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
 +
 +
local Interviewers = A['Interviewers']
 +
 +
local c = {}; -- contributors list from |contributor-lastn= / contributor-firstn= pairs
 +
local Contributors; -- assembled contributors name list
 +
local Contribution = A['Contribution'];
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(A['Periodical']) then -- |contributor= and |contribution= only supported in book cites
 +
c = extract_names (args, 'ContributorList'); -- fetch contributor list from |contributorn= / |contributor-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
 +
 +
if 0 < #c then
 +
if not is_set (Contribution) then -- |contributor= requires |contribution=
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'contribution')}); -- add missing contribution error message
 +
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
 +
end
 +
if 0 == #a then -- |contributor= requires |author=
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'author')}); -- add missing author error message
 +
c = {}; -- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
 +
end
 +
end
 +
else -- if not a book cite
 +
if select_one (args, cfg.aliases['ContributorList-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', 1 ) then -- are there contributor name list parameters?
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_ignored')}); -- add contributor ignored error message
 +
end
 +
Contribution = nil; -- unset
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (NameListFormat, 'name-list-format', cfg.keywords['name-list-format']) then -- only accepted value for this parameter is 'vanc'
 +
NameListFormat = ''; -- anything else, set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local Year = A['Year'];
 +
local PublicationDate = A['PublicationDate'];
 +
local OrigYear = A['OrigYear'];
 +
local Date = A['Date'];
 +
local LayDate = A['LayDate'];
 +
------------------------------------------------- Get title data
 +
local Title = A['Title'];
 +
local ScriptTitle = A['ScriptTitle'];
 +
local BookTitle = A['BookTitle'];
 +
local Conference = A['Conference'];
 +
local TransTitle = A['TransTitle'];
 +
local TitleNote = A['TitleNote'];
 +
local TitleLink = A['TitleLink'];
 +
link_title_ok (TitleLink, A:ORIGIN ('TitleLink'), Title, 'title'); -- check for wikimarkup in |title-link= or wikimarkup in |title= when |title-link= is set
 +
 
 +
local Chapter = A['Chapter'];
 +
local ScriptChapter = A['ScriptChapter'];
 +
local ChapterLink -- = A['ChapterLink']; -- deprecated as a parameter but still used internally by cite episode
 +
local TransChapter = A['TransChapter'];
 +
local TitleType = A['TitleType'];
 +
local Degree = A['Degree'];
 +
local Docket = A['Docket'];
 +
local ArchiveFormat = A['ArchiveFormat'];
 +
 
 +
local ArchiveDate;
 +
local ArchiveURL;
 +
 
 +
ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate = archive_url_check (A['ArchiveURL'], A['ArchiveDate'])
 +
 +
local DeadURL = A['DeadURL']
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (DeadURL, 'dead-url', cfg.keywords ['deadurl']) then -- set in config.defaults to 'yes'
 +
DeadURL = ''; -- anything else, set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local URL = A['URL']
 +
local URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL'); -- get name of parameter that holds URL
 +
local ChapterURL = A['ChapterURL'];
 +
local ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ChapterURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ChapterURL
 +
local ConferenceFormat = A['ConferenceFormat'];
 +
local ConferenceURL = A['ConferenceURL'];
 +
local ConferenceURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ConferenceURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds ConferenceURL
 +
local Periodical = A['Periodical'];
 +
local Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('Periodical'); -- get the name of the periodical parameter
 +
 
 +
local Series = A['Series'];
 +
 +
local Volume;
 +
local Issue;
 +
local Page;
 +
local Pages;
 +
local At;
 +
-- previously conference books did not support volume
 +
-- if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) and not ('conference' == config.CitationClass and not is_set (Periodical)) then
 +
if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) then
 +
Volume = A['Volume'];
 +
end
 +
-- conference & map books do not support issue
 +
if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_issue) and not (in_array (config.CitationClass, {'conference', 'map'}) and not is_set (Periodical))then
 +
Issue = A['Issue'];
 +
end
 +
local Position = '';
 +
if not in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_not_using_page) then
 +
Page = A['Page'];
 +
Pages = hyphen_to_dash( A['Pages'] );
 +
At = A['At'];
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local Edition = A['Edition'];
 +
local PublicationPlace = A['PublicationPlace']
 +
local Place = A['Place'];
 +
 +
local PublisherName = A['PublisherName'];
 +
local RegistrationRequired = A['RegistrationRequired'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (RegistrationRequired, 'registration', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
RegistrationRequired=nil;
 +
end
 +
local SubscriptionRequired = A['SubscriptionRequired'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (SubscriptionRequired, 'subscription', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
SubscriptionRequired=nil;
 +
end
 +
local UrlAccess = A['UrlAccess'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (UrlAccess, 'url-access', cfg.keywords ['url-access']) then
 +
UrlAccess = nil;
 +
end
 +
if not is_set(URL) and is_set(UrlAccess) then
 +
UrlAccess = nil;
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_access_requires_param', {'url'}, true ) } );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then -- while not aliases, these are much the same so if both are set
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'subscription')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
SubscriptionRequired = nil; -- unset; prefer |access= over |subscription=
 +
end
 +
if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (RegistrationRequired) then -- these are not the same but contradictory so if both are set
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'registration')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
RegistrationRequired = nil; -- unset; prefer |access= over |registration=
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
local Via = A['Via'];
 +
local AccessDate = A['AccessDate'];
 +
local Agency = A['Agency'];
 +
 
 +
local Language = A['Language'];
 +
local Format = A['Format'];
 +
local ChapterFormat = A['ChapterFormat'];
 +
local DoiBroken = A['DoiBroken'];
 +
local ID = A['ID'];
 +
local ASINTLD = A['ASINTLD'];
 +
local IgnoreISBN = A['IgnoreISBN'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (IgnoreISBN, 'ignore-isbn-error', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
IgnoreISBN = nil; -- anything else, set to empty string
 +
end
 +
local Embargo = A['Embargo'];
 +
local Class = A['Class']; -- arxiv class identifier
 +
 
 +
local ID_list = extract_ids( args );
 +
local ID_access_levels = extract_id_access_levels( args, ID_list );
 +
 
 +
local Quote = A['Quote'];
 +
 
 +
local LayFormat = A['LayFormat'];
 +
local LayURL = A['LayURL'];
 +
local LaySource = A['LaySource'];
 +
local Transcript = A['Transcript'];
 +
local TranscriptFormat = A['TranscriptFormat'];
 +
local TranscriptURL = A['TranscriptURL']
 +
local TranscriptURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('TranscriptURL'); -- get name of parameter that holds TranscriptURL
 +
 
 +
local LastAuthorAmp = A['LastAuthorAmp'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (LastAuthorAmp, 'last-author-amp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
LastAuthorAmp = nil; -- set to empty string
 +
end
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
LastAuthorAmp = 'yes'; -- replaces last author/editor separator with ' and ' text
 +
end
 +
local no_tracking_cats = A['NoTracking'];
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (no_tracking_cats, 'no-tracking', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
no_tracking_cats = nil; -- set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--these deprecated parameters are used by cite interview
 +
local Callsign = A['Callsign'];
 +
local City = A['City'];
 +
local Program = A['Program'];
 +
 
 +
--local variables that are not cs1 parameters
 +
local use_lowercase; -- controls capitalization of certain static text
 +
local this_page = mw.title.getCurrentTitle(); -- also used for COinS and for language
 +
local anchor_year; -- used in the CITEREF identifier
 +
local COinS_date = {}; -- holds date info extracted from |date= for the COinS metadata by Module:Date verification
 +
 
 +
local DF = A['DF']; -- date format set in cs1|2 template
 +
if not is_valid_parameter_value (DF, 'df', cfg.keywords['date-format']) then -- validate reformatting keyword
 +
DF = ''; -- not valid, set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local sepc; -- separator between citation elements for CS1 a period, for CS2, a comma
 +
local PostScript;
 +
local Ref;
 +
sepc, PostScript, Ref = set_style (Mode:lower(), A['PostScript'], A['Ref'], config.CitationClass);
 +
use_lowercase = ( sepc == ',' ); -- used to control capitalization for certain static text
 +
 
 +
--check this page to see if it is in one of the namespaces that cs1 is not supposed to add to the error categories
 +
if not is_set (no_tracking_cats) then -- ignore if we are already not going to categorize this page
 +
if in_array (this_page.nsText, cfg.uncategorized_namespaces) then
 +
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
 +
end
 +
for _,v in ipairs (cfg.uncategorized_subpages) do -- cycle through page name patterns
 +
if this_page.text:match (v) then -- test page name against each pattern
 +
no_tracking_cats = "true"; -- set no_tracking_cats
 +
break; -- bail out if one is found
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- check for extra |page=, |pages= or |at= parameters. (also sheet and sheets while we're at it)
 +
select_one( args, {'page', 'p', 'pp', 'pages', 'at', 'sheet', 'sheets'}, 'redundant_parameters' ); -- this is a dummy call simply to get the error message and category
 +
 
 +
local NoPP = A['NoPP']
 +
if is_set (NoPP) and is_valid_parameter_value (NoPP, 'nopp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
 +
NoPP = true;
 +
else
 +
NoPP = nil; -- unset, used as a flag later
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Page) then
 +
if is_set(Pages) or is_set(At) then
 +
Pages = ''; -- unset the others
 +
At = '';
 +
end
 +
extra_text_in_page_check (Page); -- add this page to maint cat if |page= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
 +
elseif is_set(Pages) then
 +
if is_set(At) then
 +
At = ''; -- unset
 +
end
 +
extra_text_in_page_check (Pages); -- add this page to maint cat if |pages= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- both |publication-place= and |place= (|location=) allowed if different
 +
if not is_set(PublicationPlace) and is_set(Place) then
 +
PublicationPlace = Place; -- promote |place= (|location=) to |publication-place
 +
end
 +
 +
if PublicationPlace == Place then Place = ''; end -- don't need both if they are the same
 +
 +
--[[
 +
Parameter remapping for cite encyclopedia:
 +
When the citation has these parameters:
 +
|encyclopedia and |title then map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
 +
|encyclopedia and |article then map |encyclopedia to |title
 +
|encyclopedia then map |encyclopedia to |title
 +
 
 +
|trans_title maps to |trans_chapter when |title is re-mapped
 +
|url maps to |chapterurl when |title is remapped
 +
 
 +
All other combinations of |encyclopedia, |title, and |article are not modified
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
 
 +
local Encyclopedia = A['Encyclopedia'];
 +
 
 +
if ( config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) or ( config.CitationClass == "citation" and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then -- test code for citation
 +
if is_set(Periodical) then -- Periodical is set when |encyclopedia is set
 +
if is_set(Title) or is_set (ScriptTitle) then
 +
if not is_set(Chapter) then
 +
Chapter = Title; -- |encyclopedia and |title are set so map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
 +
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
 +
TransChapter = TransTitle;
 +
ChapterURL = URL;
 +
if not is_set (ChapterURL) and is_set (TitleLink) then
 +
Chapter= '[[' .. TitleLink .. '|' .. Chapter .. ']]';
 +
end
 +
Title = Periodical;
 +
ChapterFormat = Format;
 +
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
 +
TransTitle = '';
 +
URL = '';
 +
Format = '';
 +
TitleLink = '';
 +
ScriptTitle = '';
 +
end
 +
else -- |title not set
 +
Title = Periodical; -- |encyclopedia set and |article set or not set so map |encyclopedia to |title
 +
Periodical = ''; -- redundant so unset
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- Special case for cite techreport.
 +
if (config.CitationClass == "techreport") then -- special case for cite techreport
 +
if is_set(A['Number']) then -- cite techreport uses 'number', which other citations alias to 'issue'
 +
if not is_set(ID) then -- can we use ID for the "number"?
 +
ID = A['Number']; -- yes, use it
 +
else -- ID has a value so emit error message
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error('redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'id') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'number')}, true )});
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- special case for cite interview
 +
-- TODO: make cite interview not need any special cases
 +
--[[
 +
Program, Callsign, City deprecated, so avoid using /Configuration
 +
for reassignment, which would allow these parameters' use outside interview
 +
]]
 +
if (config.CitationClass == "interview") then
 +
if is_set(Program) then
 +
if not is_set(Periodical) then
 +
Periodical = Program;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set(Callsign) then
 +
if not is_set(PublisherName) then
 +
PublisherName = Callsign;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set(City) then
 +
if not is_set(PublicationPlace) then
 +
PublicationPlace = City;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- special case for cite mailing list
 +
if (config.CitationClass == "mailinglist") then
 +
Periodical = A ['MailingList'];
 +
elseif 'mailinglist' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then
 +
Periodical = ''; -- unset because mailing list is only used for cite mailing list
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite conference}}, before generation of COinS data.
 +
if 'conference' == config.CitationClass then
 +
if is_set(BookTitle) then
 +
Chapter = Title;
 +
-- ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- |chapterlink= is deprecated
 +
ChapterURL = URL;
 +
ChapterURLorigin = URLorigin;
 +
URLorigin = '';
 +
ChapterFormat = Format;
 +
TransChapter = TransTitle;
 +
Title = BookTitle;
 +
Format = '';
 +
-- TitleLink = '';
 +
TransTitle = '';
 +
URL = '';
 +
end
 +
elseif 'speech' ~= config.CitationClass then
 +
Conference = ''; -- not cite conference or cite speech so make sure this is empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- cite map oddities
 +
local Cartography = "";
 +
local Scale = "";
 +
local Sheet = A['Sheet'] or '';
 +
local Sheets = A['Sheets'] or '';
 +
if config.CitationClass == "map" then
 +
Chapter = A['Map'];
 +
ChapterURL = A['MapURL'];
 +
TransChapter = A['TransMap'];
 +
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('MapURL');
 +
ChapterFormat = A['MapFormat'];
 +
 +
Cartography = A['Cartography'];
 +
if is_set( Cartography ) then
 +
Cartography = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('cartography', Cartography, use_lowercase);
 +
end
 +
Scale = A['Scale'];
 +
if is_set( Scale ) then
 +
Scale = sepc .. " " .. Scale;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite episode}} and {{cite serial}}, before generation of COinS data.
 +
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass or 'serial' == config.CitationClass then
 +
local AirDate = A['AirDate'];
 +
local SeriesLink = A['SeriesLink'];
 +
 
 +
link_title_ok (SeriesLink, A:ORIGIN ('SeriesLink'), Series, 'series'); -- check for wikimarkup in |series-link= or wikimarkup in |series= when |series-link= is set
 +
 
 +
local Network = A['Network'];
 +
local Station = A['Station'];
 +
local s, n = {}, {};
 +
-- do common parameters first
 +
if is_set(Network) then table.insert(n, Network); end
 +
if is_set(Station) then table.insert(n, Station); end
 +
ID = table.concat(n, sepc .. ' ');
 +
 +
if not is_set (Date) and is_set (AirDate) then -- promote airdate to date
 +
Date = AirDate;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- handle the oddities that are strictly {{cite episode}}
 +
local Season = A['Season'];
 +
local SeriesNumber = A['SeriesNumber'];
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Season) and is_set (SeriesNumber) then -- these are mutually exclusive so if both are set
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'season') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'seriesno')}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
SeriesNumber = ''; -- unset; prefer |season= over |seriesno=
 +
end
 +
-- assemble a table of parts concatenated later into Series
 +
if is_set(Season) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('season', Season, use_lowercase)); end
 +
if is_set(SeriesNumber) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('series', SeriesNumber, use_lowercase)); end
 +
if is_set(Issue) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('episode', Issue, use_lowercase)); end
 +
Issue = ''; -- unset because this is not a unique parameter
 +
 +
Chapter = Title; -- promote title parameters to chapter
 +
ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
 +
ChapterLink = TitleLink; -- alias episodelink
 +
TransChapter = TransTitle;
 +
ChapterURL = URL;
 +
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL');
 +
 +
Title = Series; -- promote series to title
 +
TitleLink = SeriesLink;
 +
Series = table.concat(s, sepc .. ' '); -- this is concatenation of season, seriesno, episode number
 +
 
 +
if is_set (ChapterLink) and not is_set (ChapterURL) then -- link but not URL
 +
Chapter = '[[' .. ChapterLink .. '|' .. Chapter .. ']]'; -- ok to wikilink
 +
elseif is_set (ChapterLink) and is_set (ChapterURL) then -- if both are set, URL links episode;
 +
Series = '[[' .. ChapterLink .. '|' .. Series .. ']]'; -- series links with ChapterLink (episodelink -> TitleLink -> ChapterLink) ugly
 +
end
 +
URL = ''; -- unset
 +
TransTitle = '';
 +
ScriptTitle = '';
 +
 +
else -- now oddities that are cite serial
 +
Issue = ''; -- unset because this parameter no longer supported by the citation/core version of cite serial
 +
Chapter = A['Episode']; -- TODO: make |episode= available to cite episode someday?
 +
if is_set (Series) and is_set (SeriesLink) then
 +
Series = '[[' .. SeriesLink .. '|' .. Series .. ']]';
 +
end
 +
Series = wrap_style ('italic-title', Series); -- series is italicized
 +
end
 +
end
 +
-- end of {{cite episode}} stuff
 +
 
 +
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, before generation of COinS data.
 +
if 'arxiv' == config.CitationClass then
 +
if not is_set (ID_list['ARXIV']) then -- |arxiv= or |eprint= required for cite arxiv
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'arxiv_missing', {}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
elseif is_set (Series) then -- series is an alias of version
 +
ID_list['ARXIV'] = ID_list['ARXIV'] .. Series; -- concatenate version onto the end of the arxiv identifier
 +
Series = ''; -- unset
 +
deprecated_parameter ('version'); -- deprecated parameter but only for cite arxiv
 +
end
 +
 +
if first_set ({AccessDate, At, Authors, Chapter, Format, Page, Pages, Periodical, PublisherName, URL, -- a crude list of parameters that are not supported by cite arxiv
 +
ID_list['ASIN'], ID_list['BIBCODE'], ID_list['DOI'], ID_list['ISBN'], ID_list['ISSN'], -- TODO: find a better way to do this
 +
ID_list['JFM'], ID_list['JSTOR'], ID_list['LCCN'], ID_list['MR'], ID_list['OCLC'], ID_list['OL'],
 +
ID_list['OSTI'], ID_list['PMC'], ID_list['PMID'], ID_list['RFC'], ID_list['SSRN'], ID_list['USENETID'], ID_list['ZBL']},27) then
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'arxiv_params_not_supported', {}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
 
 +
AccessDate = ''; -- set these to empty string; not supported in cite arXiv
 +
Authors = '';
 +
PublisherName = ''; -- (if the article has been published, use cite journal, or other)
 +
Chapter = '';
 +
URL = '';
 +
Format = '';
 +
Page = ''; Pages = ''; At = '';
 +
end
 +
Periodical = 'arXiv'; -- set to arXiv for COinS; after that, must be set to empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- handle type parameter for those CS1 citations that have default values
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"AV-media-notes", "interview", "mailinglist", "map", "podcast", "pressrelease", "report", "techreport", "thesis"}) then
 +
TitleType = set_titletype (config.CitationClass, TitleType);
 +
if is_set(Degree) and "Thesis" == TitleType then -- special case for cite thesis
 +
TitleType = Degree .. ' ' .. cfg.title_types ['thesis']:lower();
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(TitleType) then -- if type parameter is specified
 +
TitleType = substitute( cfg.messages['type'], TitleType); -- display it in parentheses
 +
-- TODO: Hack on TitleType to fix bunched parentheses problem
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- legacy: promote PublicationDate to Date if neither Date nor Year are set.
 +
if not is_set (Date) then
 +
Date = Year; -- promote Year to Date
 +
Year = nil; -- make nil so Year as empty string isn't used for CITEREF
 +
if not is_set (Date) and is_set(PublicationDate) then -- use PublicationDate when |date= and |year= are not set
 +
Date = PublicationDate; -- promote PublicationDate to Date
 +
PublicationDate = ''; -- unset, no longer needed
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if PublicationDate == Date then PublicationDate = ''; end -- if PublicationDate is same as Date, don't display in rendered citation
 +
 
 +
--[[
 +
Go test all of the date-holding parameters for valid MOS:DATE format and make sure that dates are real dates. This must be done before we do COinS because here is where
 +
we get the date used in the metadata.
 +
 
 +
Date validation supporting code is in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
 +
]]
 +
do -- create defined block to contain local variables error_message, date_parameters_list, mismatch
 +
local error_message = '';
 +
-- AirDate has been promoted to Date so not necessary to check it
 +
local date_parameters_list = {['access-date']=AccessDate, ['archive-date']=ArchiveDate, ['date']=Date, ['doi-broken-date']=DoiBroken,
 +
['embargo']=Embargo, ['lay-date']=LayDate, ['publication-date']=PublicationDate, ['year']=Year};
 +
 
 +
anchor_year, Embargo, error_message = dates(date_parameters_list, COinS_date);
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Year) and is_set (Date) then -- both |date= and |year= not normally needed;
 +
local mismatch = year_date_check (Year, Date)
 +
if 0 == mismatch then -- |year= does not match a year-value in |date=
 +
if is_set (error_message) then -- if there is already an error message
 +
error_message = error_message .. ', '; -- tack on this additional message
 +
end
 +
error_message = error_message .. '&#124;year= / &#124;date= mismatch';
 +
elseif 1 == mismatch then -- |year= matches year-value in |date=
 +
add_maint_cat ('date_year');
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
if not is_set(error_message) then -- error free dates only
 +
local modified = false; -- flag
 +
if is_set (DF) then -- if we need to reformat dates
 +
modified = reformat_dates (date_parameters_list, DF, false); -- reformat to DF format, use long month names if appropriate
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if true == date_hyphen_to_dash (date_parameters_list) then -- convert hyphens to dashes where appropriate
 +
modified = true;
 +
add_maint_cat ('date_format'); -- hyphens were converted so add maint category
 +
end
 +
 +
if modified then -- if the date_parameters_list values were modified
 +
AccessDate = date_parameters_list['access-date']; -- overwrite date holding parameters with modified values
 +
ArchiveDate = date_parameters_list['archive-date'];
 +
Date = date_parameters_list['date'];
 +
DoiBroken = date_parameters_list['doi-broken-date'];
 +
LayDate = date_parameters_list['lay-date'];
 +
PublicationDate = date_parameters_list['publication-date'];
 +
end
 +
else
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_date', {error_message}, true ) } ); -- add this error message
 +
end
 +
end -- end of do
 +
 
 +
-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite journal}} with |pmc= set and |url= not set.  Do this after date check but before COInS.
 +
-- Here we unset Embargo if PMC not embargoed (|embargo= not set in the citation) or if the embargo time has expired. Otherwise, holds embargo date
 +
Embargo = is_embargoed (Embargo); --
 +
 
 +
if config.CitationClass == "journal" and not is_set(URL) and is_set(ID_list['PMC']) then
 +
if not is_set (Embargo) then -- if not embargoed or embargo has expired
 +
URL=cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].prefix .. ID_list['PMC']; -- set url to be the same as the PMC external link if not embargoed
 +
URLorigin = cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].parameters[1]; -- set URLorigin to parameter name for use in error message if citation is missing a |title=
 +
if is_set(AccessDate) then -- access date requires |url=; pmc created url is not |url=
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
 +
AccessDate = ''; -- unset
 +
end
 +
 
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- At this point fields may be nil if they weren't specified in the template use.  We can use that fact.
 +
-- Test if citation has no title
 +
if not is_set(Title) and
 +
not is_set(TransTitle) and
 +
not is_set(ScriptTitle) then
 +
if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite episode; TODO: is there a better way to do this?
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'series'}, true ) } );
 +
else
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'title'}, true ) } );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
if 'none' == Title and in_array (config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'citation'}) and is_set (Periodical) and 'journal' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then -- special case for journal cites
 +
Title = ''; -- set title to empty string
 +
add_maint_cat ('untitled');
 +
end
 +
 
 +
check_for_url ({ -- add error message when any of these parameters contains a URL
 +
['title']=Title,
 +
[A:ORIGIN('Chapter')]=Chapter,
 +
[A:ORIGIN('Periodical')]=Periodical,
 +
[A:ORIGIN('PublisherName')] = PublisherName
 +
});
 +
 
 +
-- COinS metadata (see <http://ocoins.info/>) for automated parsing of citation information.
 +
-- handle the oddity that is cite encyclopedia and {{citation |encyclopedia=something}}. Here we presume that
 +
-- when Periodical, Title, and Chapter are all set, then Periodical is the book (encyclopedia) title, Title
 +
-- is the article title, and Chapter is a section within the article.  So, we remap
 +
 +
local coins_chapter = Chapter; -- default assuming that remapping not required
 +
local coins_title = Title; -- et tu
 +
if 'encyclopaedia' == config.CitationClass or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
 +
if is_set (Chapter) and is_set (Title) and is_set (Periodical) then -- if all are used then
 +
coins_chapter = Title; -- remap
 +
coins_title = Periodical;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
local coins_author = a; -- default for coins rft.au
 +
if 0 < #c then -- but if contributor list
 +
coins_author = c; -- use that instead
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- this is the function call to COinS()
 +
local OCinSoutput = COinS({
 +
['Periodical'] = Periodical,
 +
['Encyclopedia'] = Encyclopedia,
 +
['Chapter'] = make_coins_title (coins_chapter, ScriptChapter), -- Chapter and ScriptChapter stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
 +
['Degree'] = Degree; -- cite thesis only
 +
['Title'] = make_coins_title (coins_title, ScriptTitle), -- Title and ScriptTitle stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
 +
['PublicationPlace'] = PublicationPlace,
 +
['Date'] = COinS_date.rftdate, -- COinS_date has correctly formatted date if Date is valid;
 +
['Season'] = COinS_date.rftssn,
 +
['Chron'] =  COinS_date.rftchron or (not COinS_date.rftdate and Date) or '', -- chron but if not set and invalid date format use Date; keep this last bit?
 +
['Series'] = Series,
 +
['Volume'] = Volume,
 +
['Issue'] = Issue,
 +
['Pages'] = get_coins_pages (first_set ({Sheet, Sheets, Page, Pages, At}, 5)), -- pages stripped of external links
 +
['Edition'] = Edition,
 +
['PublisherName'] = PublisherName,
 +
['URL'] = first_set ({ChapterURL, URL}, 2),
 +
['Authors'] = coins_author,
 +
['ID_list'] = ID_list,
 +
['RawPage'] = this_page.prefixedText,
 +
}, config.CitationClass);
 +
 
 +
-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, AFTER generation of COinS data.
 +
if 'arxiv' == config.CitationClass then -- we have set rft.jtitle in COinS to arXiv, now unset so it isn't displayed
 +
Periodical = ''; -- periodical not allowed in cite arxiv; if article has been published, use cite journal
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- special case for cite newsgroup.  Do this after COinS because we are modifying Publishername to include some static text
 +
if 'newsgroup' == config.CitationClass then
 +
if is_set (PublisherName) then
 +
PublisherName = substitute (cfg.messages['newsgroup'], external_link( 'news:' .. PublisherName, PublisherName, A:ORIGIN('PublisherName'), nil ));
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
 
 +
 
 +
-- Now perform various field substitutions.
 +
-- We also add leading spaces and surrounding markup and punctuation to the
 +
-- various parts of the citation, but only when they are non-nil.
 +
local EditorCount; -- used only for choosing {ed.) or (eds.) annotation at end of editor name-list
 +
do
 +
local last_first_list;
 +
local control = {
 +
format = NameListFormat, -- empty string or 'vanc'
 +
maximum = nil, -- as if display-authors or display-editors not set
 +
lastauthoramp = LastAuthorAmp,
 +
page_name = this_page.text, -- get current page name so that we don't wikilink to it via editorlinkn
 +
mode = Mode
 +
};
 +
 
 +
do -- do editor name list first because coauthors can modify control table
 +
control.maximum , editor_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayEditors'], #e, 'editors', editor_etal);
 +
last_first_list, EditorCount = list_people(control, e, editor_etal);
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Editors) then
 +
if editor_etal then
 +
Editors = Editors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- add et al. to editors parameter beause |display-editors=etal
 +
EditorCount = 2; -- with et al., |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
 +
else
 +
EditorCount = 2; -- we don't know but assume |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
 +
end
 +
else
 +
Editors = last_first_list; -- either an author name list or an empty string
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if 1 == EditorCount and (true == editor_etal or 1 < #e) then -- only one editor displayed but includes etal then
 +
EditorCount = 2; -- spoof to display (eds.) annotation
 +
end
 +
end
 +
do -- now do translators
 +
control.maximum = #t; -- number of translators
 +
Translators = list_people(control, t, false); -- et al not currently supported
 +
end
 +
do -- now do contributors
 +
control.maximum = #c; -- number of contributors
 +
Contributors = list_people(control, c, false); -- et al not currently supported
 +
end
 +
do -- now do authors
 +
control.maximum , author_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayAuthors'], #a, 'authors', author_etal);
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Coauthors) then -- if the coauthor field is also used, prevent ampersand and et al. formatting.
 +
control.lastauthoramp = nil;
 +
control.maximum = #a + 1;
 +
end
 +
 +
last_first_list = list_people(control, a, author_etal);
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Authors) then
 +
Authors, author_etal = name_has_etal (Authors, author_etal, false); -- find and remove variations on et al.
 +
if author_etal then
 +
Authors = Authors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al']; -- add et al. to authors parameter
 +
end
 +
else
 +
Authors = last_first_list; -- either an author name list or an empty string
 +
end
 +
end -- end of do
 +
 +
if is_set (Authors) and is_set (Collaboration) then
 +
Authors = Authors .. ' (' .. Collaboration .. ')'; -- add collaboration after et al.
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if not is_set(Authors) and is_set(Coauthors) then -- coauthors aren't displayed if one of authors=, authorn=, or lastn= isn't specified
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error('coauthors_missing_author', {}, true) } ); -- emit error message
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- apply |[xx-]format= styling; at the end, these parameters hold correctly styled format annotation,
 +
-- an error message if the associated url is not set, or an empty string for concatenation
 +
ArchiveFormat = style_format (ArchiveFormat, ArchiveURL, 'archive-format', 'archive-url');
 +
ConferenceFormat = style_format (ConferenceFormat, ConferenceURL, 'conference-format', 'conference-url');
 +
Format = style_format (Format, URL, 'format', 'url');
 +
LayFormat = style_format (LayFormat, LayURL, 'lay-format', 'lay-url');
 +
TranscriptFormat = style_format (TranscriptFormat, TranscriptURL, 'transcript-format', 'transcripturl');
 +
 
 +
-- special case for chapter format so no error message or cat when chapter not supported
 +
if not (in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv'}) or
 +
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia))) then
 +
ChapterFormat = style_format (ChapterFormat, ChapterURL, 'chapter-format', 'chapter-url');
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if not is_set(URL) then
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"web","podcast", "mailinglist"}) then -- |url= required for cite web, cite podcast, and cite mailinglist
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'cite_web_url', {}, true ) } );
 +
end
 +
 +
-- do we have |accessdate= without either |url= or |chapter-url=?
 +
if is_set(AccessDate) and not is_set(ChapterURL)then -- ChapterURL may be set when URL is not set;
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
 +
AccessDate = '';
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local OriginalURL, OriginalURLorigin, OriginalFormat, OriginalAccess;
 +
DeadURL = DeadURL:lower(); -- used later when assembling archived text
 +
if is_set( ArchiveURL ) then
 +
if is_set (ChapterURL) then -- URL not set so if chapter-url is set apply archive url to it
 +
OriginalURL = ChapterURL; -- save copy of source chapter's url for archive text
 +
OriginalURLorigin = ChapterURLorigin; -- name of chapter-url parameter for error messages
 +
OriginalFormat = ChapterFormat; -- and original |format=
 +
if 'no' ~= DeadURL then
 +
ChapterURL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's url
 +
ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of archive-url parameter for error messages
 +
ChapterFormat = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set (URL) then
 +
OriginalURL = URL; -- save copy of original source URL
 +
OriginalURLorigin = URLorigin; -- name of url parameter for error messages
 +
OriginalFormat = Format; -- and original |format=
 +
OriginalAccess = UrlAccess;
 +
if 'no' ~= DeadURL then -- if URL set then archive-url applies to it
 +
URL = ArchiveURL -- swap-in the archive's url
 +
URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL') -- name of archive url parameter for error messages
 +
Format = ArchiveFormat or ''; -- swap in archive's format
 +
UrlAccess = nil; -- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived urls
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv'}) or -- if any of the 'periodical' cites except encyclopedia
 +
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
 +
local chap_param;
 +
if is_set (Chapter) then -- get a parameter name from one of these chapter related meta-parameters
 +
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('Chapter')
 +
elseif is_set (TransChapter) then
 +
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('TransChapter')
 +
elseif is_set (ChapterURL) then
 +
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterURL')
 +
elseif is_set (ScriptChapter) then
 +
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ScriptChapter')
 +
else is_set (ChapterFormat)
 +
chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterFormat')
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (chap_param) then -- if we found one
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'chapter_ignored', {chap_param}, true ) } ); -- add error message
 +
Chapter = ''; -- and set them to empty string to be safe with concatenation
 +
TransChapter = '';
 +
ChapterURL = '';
 +
ScriptChapter = '';
 +
ChapterFormat = '';
 +
end
 +
else -- otherwise, format chapter / article title
 +
local no_quotes = false; -- default assume that we will be quoting the chapter parameter value
 +
if is_set (Contribution) and 0 < #c then -- if this is a contribution with contributor(s)
 +
if in_array (Contribution:lower(), cfg.keywords.contribution) then -- and a generic contribution title
 +
no_quotes = true; -- then render it unquoted
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
Chapter = format_chapter_title (ScriptChapter, Chapter, TransChapter, ChapterURL, ChapterURLorigin, no_quotes); -- Contribution is also in Chapter
 +
if is_set (Chapter) then
 +
Chapter = Chapter .. ChapterFormat ;
 +
if 'map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (TitleType) then
 +
Chapter = Chapter .. ' ' .. TitleType; -- map annotation here; not after title
 +
end
 +
Chapter = Chapter.. sepc .. ' ';
 +
elseif is_set (ChapterFormat) then -- |chapter= not set but |chapter-format= is so ...
 +
Chapter = ChapterFormat .. sepc .. ' '; -- ... ChapterFormat has error message, we want to see it
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- Format main title.
 +
if is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(Title) then
 +
Title = "[[" .. TitleLink .. "|" .. Title .. "]]"
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'mailinglist', 'arxiv', 'interview'}) or
 +
('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) or
 +
('map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical)) then -- special case for cite map when the map is in a periodical treat as an article
 +
Title = kern_quotes (Title); -- if necessary, separate title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
 +
Title = wrap_style ('quoted-title', Title);
 +
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
 +
TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle );
 +
elseif 'report' == config.CitationClass then -- no styling for cite report
 +
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
 +
TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle ); -- for cite report, use this form for trans-title
 +
else
 +
Title = wrap_style ('italic-title', Title);
 +
Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle); -- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
 +
TransTitle = wrap_style ('trans-italic-title', TransTitle);
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local TransError = "";
 +
if is_set(TransTitle) then
 +
if is_set(Title) then
 +
TransTitle = " " .. TransTitle;
 +
else
 +
TransError = " " .. set_error( 'trans_missing_title', {'title'} );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
Title = Title .. TransTitle;
 +
 +
if is_set(Title) then
 +
if not is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(URL) then
 +
 +
Title = external_link( URL, Title, URLorigin, UrlAccess ) .. TransError .. Format;
 +
-- this experiment hidden 2016-04-10; see Help_talk:Citation_Style_1#Recycled_urls
 +
-- local temp_title = external_link( URL, Title, URLorigin ) .. TransError .. Format; -- do this so we get error message even if url is usurped no archive
 +
-- if in_array (DeadURL, {'unfit no archive', 'usurped no archive'}) then -- when url links to inappropriate location and there is no archive of original source available
 +
-- local err_msg
 +
-- if temp_title:match ('%[%S+%s+(.+)%](<.+)') then -- if there is an error message
 +
-- Title, err_msg = temp_title:match ('%[%S+%s+(.+)%](<.+)'); -- strip off external link; TODO: find a better to do this
 +
-- Title = Title .. (err_msg or '');
 +
-- end
 +
-- else
 +
-- Title = temp_title;
 +
-- end
 +
 
 +
URL = ''; -- unset these because no longer needed
 +
Format = "";
 +
else
 +
Title = Title .. TransError;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Place) then
 +
Place = " " .. wrap_msg ('written', Place, use_lowercase) .. sepc .. " ";
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Conference) then
 +
if is_set (ConferenceURL) then
 +
Conference = external_link( ConferenceURL, Conference, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
 +
end
 +
Conference = sepc .. " " .. Conference .. ConferenceFormat;
 +
elseif is_set(ConferenceURL) then
 +
Conference = sepc .. " " .. external_link( ConferenceURL, nil, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if not is_set(Position) then
 +
local Minutes = A['Minutes'];
 +
local Time = A['Time'];
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Minutes) then
 +
if is_set (Time) then
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'minutes') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'time')}, true ) } );
 +
end
 +
Position = " " .. Minutes .. " " .. cfg.messages['minutes'];
 +
else
 +
if is_set(Time) then
 +
local TimeCaption = A['TimeCaption']
 +
if not is_set(TimeCaption) then
 +
TimeCaption = cfg.messages['event'];
 +
if sepc ~= '.' then
 +
TimeCaption = TimeCaption:lower();
 +
end
 +
end
 +
Position = " " .. TimeCaption .. " " .. Time;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
else
 +
Position = " " .. Position;
 +
At = '';
 +
end
 +
 
 +
Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets = format_pages_sheets (Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, NoPP, use_lowercase, Mode);
 +
 
 +
At = is_set(At) and (sepc .. " " .. At) or "";
 +
Position = is_set(Position) and (sepc .. " " .. Position) or "";
 +
if config.CitationClass == 'map' then
 +
local Section = A['Section'];
 +
local Sections = A['Sections'];
 +
local Inset = A['Inset'];
 +
 +
if is_set( Inset ) then
 +
Inset = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('inset', Inset, use_lowercase);
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set( Sections ) then
 +
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('sections', Sections, use_lowercase);
 +
elseif is_set( Section ) then
 +
Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('section', Section, use_lowercase);
 +
end
 +
At = At .. Inset .. Section;
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set (Language) then
 +
Language = language_parameter (Language); -- format, categories, name from ISO639-1, etc
 +
else
 +
Language=""; -- language not specified so make sure this is an empty string;
 +
--[[ TODO: need to extract the wrap_msg from language_parameter
 +
so that we can solve parentheses bunching problem with Format/Language/TitleType
 +
]]
 +
end
 +
 
 +
Others = is_set(Others) and (sepc .. " " .. Others) or "";
 +
 +
if is_set (Translators) then
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
Others = sepc .. ' Trans. ' .. Translators .. Others;
 +
else
 +
Others = sepc .. ' ' .. wrap_msg ('translated', Translators, use_lowercase) .. Others;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set (Interviewers) then
 +
Others = sepc .. ' ' .. wrap_msg ('interview', Interviewers, use_lowercase) .. Others;
 +
end
 +
 +
TitleNote = is_set(TitleNote) and (sepc .. " " .. TitleNote) or "";
 +
if is_set (Edition) then
 +
if Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]d%.?$') or Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]dition$') then
 +
add_maint_cat ('extra_text', 'edition');
 +
end
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
Edition = '. ' .. Edition .. ' ed.';
 +
else
 +
Edition = " " .. wrap_msg ('edition', Edition);
 +
end
 +
else
 +
Edition = '';
 +
end
 +
 
 +
Series = is_set(Series) and (sepc .. " " .. Series) or "";
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then -- not in brackets for mla
 +
OrigYear = is_set(OrigYear) and (". " .. OrigYear) or "";
 +
else
 +
OrigYear = is_set(OrigYear) and (" [" .. OrigYear .. "]") or "";
 +
end
 +
Agency = is_set(Agency) and (sepc .. " " .. Agency) or "";
 +
 
 +
Volume = format_volume_issue (Volume, Issue, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, use_lowercase, Mode);
 +
 
 +
------------------------------------ totally unrelated data
 +
if is_set(Via) then
 +
Via = " " .. wrap_msg ('via', Via);
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[
 +
Subscription implies paywall; Registration does not.  If both are used in a citation, the subscription required link
 +
note is displayed. There are no error messages for this condition.
 +
 
 +
]]
 +
if is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then
 +
SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['subscription']; -- subscription required message
 +
elseif is_set (RegistrationRequired) then
 +
SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['registration']; -- registration required message
 +
else
 +
SubscriptionRequired = ''; -- either or both might be set to something other than yes true y
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(AccessDate) then
 +
local retrv_text = " " .. cfg.messages['retrieved']
 +
 
 +
AccessDate = nowrap_date (AccessDate); -- wrap in nowrap span if date in appropriate format
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then -- retrieved text not used in mla
 +
AccessDate = ' ' .. AccessDate;
 +
else
 +
if (sepc ~= ".") then retrv_text = retrv_text:lower() end -- if mode is cs2, lower case
 +
AccessDate = substitute (retrv_text, AccessDate); -- add retrieved text
 +
end
 +
AccessDate = substitute (cfg.presentation['accessdate'], {sepc, AccessDate}); -- allow editors to hide accessdates
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set(ID) then ID = sepc .." ".. ID; end
 +
  if "thesis" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then
 +
ID = sepc .." Docket ".. Docket .. ID;
 +
end
 +
  if "report" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then -- for cite report when |docket= is set
 +
ID = sepc .. ' ' .. Docket; -- overwrite ID even if |id= is set
 +
end
 +
 
 +
ID_list = build_id_list( ID_list, {IdAccessLevels=ID_access_levels, DoiBroken = DoiBroken, ASINTLD = ASINTLD, IgnoreISBN = IgnoreISBN, Embargo=Embargo, Class = Class} );
 +
 
 +
if is_set(URL) then
 +
URL = " " .. external_link( URL, nil, URLorigin, Access );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Quote) then
 +
if Quote:sub(1,1) == '"' and Quote:sub(-1,-1) == '"' then -- if first and last characters of quote are quote marks
 +
Quote = Quote:sub(2,-2); -- strip them off
 +
end
 +
Quote = sepc .." " .. wrap_style ('quoted-text', Quote ); -- wrap in <q>...</q> tags
 +
PostScript = ""; -- cs1|2 does not supply terminal punctuation when |quote= is set
 +
end
 +
 +
local Archived
 +
if is_set(ArchiveURL) then
 +
if not is_set(ArchiveDate) then
 +
ArchiveDate = set_error('archive_missing_date');
 +
end
 +
if "no" == DeadURL then
 +
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived'];
 +
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
 +
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( cfg.messages['archived-not-dead'],
 +
{ external_link( ArchiveURL, arch_text, A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL'), nil ) .. ArchiveFormat, ArchiveDate } );
 +
if not is_set(OriginalURL) then
 +
Archived = Archived .. " " .. set_error('archive_missing_url');  
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set(OriginalURL) then -- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', 'y', 'unfit', 'usurped'
 +
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-dead'];
 +
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
 +
if in_array (DeadURL, {'unfit', 'usurped', 'bot: unknown'}) then
 +
Archived = sepc .. " " .. 'Archived from the original on ' .. ArchiveDate; -- format already styled
 +
if 'bot: unknown' == DeadURL then
 +
add_maint_cat ('bot:_unknown'); -- and add a category if not already added
 +
else
 +
add_maint_cat ('unfit'); -- and add a category if not already added
 +
end
 +
else -- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', or 'y'
 +
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text,
 +
{ external_link( OriginalURL, cfg.messages['original'], OriginalURLorigin, OriginalAccess ) .. OriginalFormat, ArchiveDate } ); -- format already styled
 +
end
 +
else
 +
local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-missing'];
 +
if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
 +
Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text,
 +
{ set_error('archive_missing_url'), ArchiveDate } );
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set (ArchiveFormat) then
 +
Archived = ArchiveFormat; -- if set and ArchiveURL not set ArchiveFormat has error message
 +
else
 +
Archived = ""
 +
end
 +
 +
local Lay = '';
 +
if is_set(LayURL) then
 +
if is_set(LayDate) then LayDate = " (" .. LayDate .. ")" end
 +
if is_set(LaySource) then
 +
LaySource = " &ndash; ''" .. safe_for_italics(LaySource) .. "''";
 +
else
 +
LaySource = "";
 +
end
 +
if sepc == '.' then
 +
Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary'], A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
 +
else
 +
Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary']:lower(), A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set (LayFormat) then -- Test if |lay-format= is given without giving a |lay-url=
 +
Lay = sepc .. LayFormat; -- if set and LayURL not set, then LayFormat has error message
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Transcript) then
 +
if is_set(TranscriptURL) then
 +
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, Transcript, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
 +
end
 +
Transcript = sepc .. ' ' .. Transcript .. TranscriptFormat;
 +
elseif is_set(TranscriptURL) then
 +
Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, nil, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local Publisher;
 +
if is_set(PublicationDate) then
 +
PublicationDate = wrap_msg ('published', PublicationDate);
 +
end
 +
if is_set(PublisherName) then
 +
if is_set(PublicationPlace) then
 +
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. ": " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;
 +
else
 +
Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate; 
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set(PublicationPlace) then
 +
Publisher= sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. PublicationDate;
 +
else
 +
Publisher = PublicationDate;
 +
end
 +
 +
-- Several of the above rely upon detecting this as nil, so do it last.
 +
if is_set(Periodical) then
 +
if is_set(Title) or is_set(TitleNote) then
 +
Periodical = sepc .. " " .. wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical)
 +
else
 +
Periodical = wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical)
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
--[[
 +
Handle the oddity that is cite speech.  This code overrides whatever may be the value assigned to TitleNote (through |department=) and forces it to be " (Speech)" so that
 +
the annotation directly follows the |title= parameter value in the citation rather than the |event= parameter value (if provided).
 +
]]
 +
if "speech" == config.CitationClass then -- cite speech only
 +
TitleNote = " (Speech)"; -- annotate the citation
 +
if is_set (Periodical) then -- if Periodical, perhaps because of an included |website= or |journal= parameter
 +
if is_set (Conference) then -- and if |event= is set
 +
Conference = Conference .. sepc .. " "; -- then add appropriate punctuation to the end of the Conference variable before rendering
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
-- Piece all bits together at last.  Here, all should be non-nil.
 +
-- We build things this way because it is more efficient in LUA
 +
-- not to keep reassigning to the same string variable over and over.
 +
 
 +
local tcommon;
 +
local tcommon2; -- used for book cite when |contributor= is set
 +
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
 +
if is_set(Others) then Others = Others .. sepc .. " " end
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Others, Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series,
 +
Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
elseif in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(Periodical) then -- special cases for book cites
 +
if is_set (Contributors) then -- when we are citing foreword, preface, introduction, etc
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote}, sepc ); -- author and other stuff will come after this and before tcommon2
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
elseif 'mla' == Mode then
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
 
 +
elseif 'map' == config.CitationClass then -- special cases for cite map
 +
if is_set (Chapter) then -- map in a book; TitleType is part of Chapter
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
 +
elseif is_set (Periodical) then -- map in a periodical
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Periodical, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
 +
else -- a sheet or stand-alone map
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
 +
elseif 'episode' == config.CitationClass then -- special case for cite episode
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, TitleType, Series, Transcript, Language, Edition, Publisher}, sepc );
 +
 
 +
elseif ('news' == config.CitationClass) and ('mla' == Mode) then -- special case for cite news in MLA mode
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Agency}, sepc );
 +
 
 +
elseif ('web' == config.CitationClass) and ('mla' == Mode) then -- special case for cite web in MLA mode
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language,
 +
Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
 
 +
else -- all other CS1 templates
 +
tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language,
 +
Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
 +
if #ID_list > 0 then
 +
ID_list = safe_join( { sepc .. " ",  table.concat( ID_list, sepc .. " " ), ID }, sepc );
 +
else
 +
ID_list = ID;
 +
end
 +
 +
local idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, AccessDate, Via, SubscriptionRequired, Lay, Quote }, sepc );
 +
local text;
 +
local pgtext = Position .. Sheet .. Sheets .. Page .. Pages .. At;
 +
 
 +
if is_set(Date) then
 +
if ('mla' == Mode) then
 +
if in_array (config.CitationClass, {'book', 'news', 'web'}) then
 +
Date = ', ' .. Date; -- origyear follows title in mla
 +
elseif 'journal' == config.CitationClass then
 +
Date = ', (' .. Date .. ')';
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set (Authors) or is_set (Editors) then -- date follows authors or editors when authors not set
 +
Date = " (" .. Date ..")" .. OrigYear .. sepc .. " "; -- in paranetheses
 +
else -- neither of authors and editors set
 +
if (string.sub(tcommon,-1,-1) == sepc) then -- if the last character of tcommon is sepc
 +
Date = " " .. Date .. OrigYear; -- Date does not begin with sepc
 +
else
 +
Date = sepc .. " " .. Date .. OrigYear; -- Date begins with sepc
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if is_set(Authors) then
 +
if is_set(Coauthors) then
 +
if 'vanc' == NameListFormat then -- separate authors and coauthors with proper name-list-separator
 +
Authors = Authors .. ', ' .. Coauthors;
 +
else
 +
Authors = Authors .. '; ' .. Coauthors;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if (not is_set (Date)) or ('mla' == Mode) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Authors termination
 +
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- when no date, terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
 +
end
 +
if is_set(Editors) then
 +
local in_text = " ";
 +
local post_text = "";
 +
if is_set(Chapter) and 0 == #c and 'mla' ~= Mode then
 +
in_text = in_text .. cfg.messages['in'] .. " "
 +
if (sepc ~= '.') then in_text = in_text:lower() end -- lowercase for cs2
 +
elseif is_set(Chapter) and 'mla' == Mode then
 +
if EditorCount <= 1 then
 +
in_text = '. Ed. ';
 +
else
 +
in_text = '. Eds. ';
 +
end
 +
else
 +
if EditorCount <= 1 then
 +
post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
 +
else
 +
post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
 +
end
 +
end
 +
Editors = terminate_name_list (in_text .. Editors .. post_text, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
 +
end
 +
if is_set (Contributors) then -- book cite and we're citing the intro, preface, etc
 +
local by_text = sepc .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['by'] .. ' ';
 +
if (sepc ~= '.') then by_text = by_text:lower() end -- lowercase for cs2
 +
Authors = by_text .. Authors; -- author follows title so tweak it here
 +
if is_set (Editors) and ('mla' ~= Mode)then -- when Editors make sure that Authors gets terminated
 +
Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
 +
end
 +
if (not is_set (Date)) or ('mla' == Mode) then -- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Contributors termination
 +
Contributors = terminate_name_list (Contributors, sepc); -- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
 +
end
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
text = safe_join( {Contributors, Chapter, tcommon, OrigYear, Authors, Place, Others, Editors, tcommon2, Date, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Contributors, Date, Chapter, tcommon, Authors, Place, Editors, tcommon2, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
 +
end
 +
elseif 'mla' == Mode then
 +
tcommon = tcommon .. Date; -- hack to avoid duplicate separators
 +
text = safe_join( {Authors, Chapter, Title, OrigYear, Others, Editors, Edition, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Authors, Date, Chapter, Place, Editors, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
 +
end
 +
elseif is_set(Editors) then
 +
if is_set(Date) then
 +
if EditorCount <= 1 then
 +
Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
 +
else
 +
Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
 +
end
 +
else
 +
if EditorCount <= 1 then
 +
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editor'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
 +
else
 +
Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editors'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if 'mla' == Mode then
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'news', 'web'}) and is_set(Periodical) then
 +
text = safe_join( {Editors, Title, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Editors, Chapter, Title, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Editors, Date, Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
elseif 'mla' == Mode then
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'news', 'web'}) and is_set(Periodical) then
 +
text = safe_join( {Title, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Title, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
else
 +
if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
 +
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
else
 +
text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set(PostScript) and PostScript ~= sepc then
 +
text = safe_join( {text, sepc}, sepc );  --Deals with italics, spaces, etc.
 +
text = text:sub(1,-sepc:len()-1);
 +
end
 +
 +
text = safe_join( {text, PostScript}, sepc );
 +
 
 +
-- Now enclose the whole thing in a <cite/> element
 +
local options = {};
 +
 +
if is_set(config.CitationClass) and config.CitationClass ~= "citation" then
 +
options.class = config.CitationClass;
 +
options.class = "citation " .. config.CitationClass; -- class=citation required for blue highlight when used with |ref=
 +
else
 +
options.class = "citation";
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set(Ref) and Ref:lower() ~= "none" then -- set reference anchor if appropriate
 +
local id = Ref
 +
if ('harv' == Ref ) then
 +
local namelist = {}; -- holds selected contributor, author, editor name list
 +
local year = first_set ({Year, anchor_year}, 2); -- Year first for legacy citations and for YMD dates that require disambiguation
 +
 
 +
if #c > 0 then -- if there is a contributor list
 +
namelist = c; -- select it
 +
elseif #a > 0 then -- or an author list
 +
namelist = a;
 +
elseif #e > 0 then -- or an editor list
 +
namelist = e;
 +
end
 +
if #namelist > 0 then -- if there are names in namelist
 +
id = anchor_id (namelist, year); -- go make the CITEREF anchor
 +
else
 +
id = ''; -- unset
 +
end
 +
end
 +
options.id = id;
 +
end
 +
 +
if string.len(text:gsub("<span[^>/]*>(.-)</span>", "%1"):gsub("%b<>","")) <= 2 then -- remove <span> tags and other html-like markup; then get length of what remains
 +
z.error_categories = {};
 +
text = set_error('empty_citation');
 +
z.message_tail = {};
 +
end
 +
 +
if is_set(options.id) then -- here we wrap the rendered citation in <cite ...>...</cite> tags
 +
text = substitute (cfg.presentation['cite-id'], {mw.uri.anchorEncode(options.id), mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text}); -- when |ref= is set
 +
else
 +
text = substitute (cfg.presentation['cite'], {mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text}); -- all other cases
 +
end
 +
 
 +
text = text .. substitute (cfg.presentation['ocins'], {OCinSoutput}); -- append metadata to the citation
 +
 +
if #z.message_tail ~= 0 then
 +
text = text .. " ";
 +
for i,v in ipairs( z.message_tail ) do
 +
if is_set(v[1]) then
 +
if i == #z.message_tail then
 +
text = text .. error_comment( v[1], v[2] );
 +
else
 +
text = text .. error_comment( v[1] .. "; ", v[2] );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
if #z.maintenance_cats ~= 0 then
 +
text = text .. '<span class="citation-comment" style="display:none; color:#33aa33">';
 +
for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do -- append maintenance categories
 +
text = text .. ' ' .. v .. ' ([[:Category:' .. v ..'|link]])';
 +
end
 +
text = text .. '</span>'; -- maintenance mesages (realy just the names of the categories for now)
 +
end
 +
 +
no_tracking_cats = no_tracking_cats:lower();
 +
if in_array(no_tracking_cats, {"", "no", "false", "n"}) then
 +
for _, v in ipairs( z.error_categories ) do
 +
text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
 +
end
 +
for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do -- append maintenance categories
 +
text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
 +
end
 +
for _, v in ipairs( z.properties_cats ) do -- append maintenance categories
 +
text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 +
return text
 
end
 
end
  
-- This is used by template {{efn}}.
+
--[[--------------------------< C S 1 . C I T A T I O N >------------------------------------------------------
function z.efn(frame)
+
 
    local pframe = frame:getParent()
+
This is used by templates such as {{cite book}} to create the actual citation text.
    local config = frame.args -- the arguments passed BY the template, in the wikitext of the template itself
+
 
    local args = pframe.args -- the arguments passed TO the template, in the wikitext that instantiates the template
+
]]
    return z.mw.text.tag({name="ref",contents=(args[1] or ""),params={name=args.name,group=config.default_group}}, frame)
+
 
 +
function cs1.citation(frame)
 +
Frame = frame; -- save a copy incase we need to display an error message in preview mode
 +
local pframe = frame:getParent()
 +
local validation, utilities, identifiers, metadata;
 +
 +
if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then -- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
 +
cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration/sandbox'); -- load sandbox versions of support modules
 +
whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist/sandbox');
 +
utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities/sandbox');
 +
validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation/sandbox');
 +
identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers/sandbox');
 +
metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS/sandbox');
 +
 +
else -- otherwise
 +
cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration'); -- load live versions of support modules
 +
whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist');
 +
utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities');
 +
validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation');
 +
identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers');
 +
metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS');
 +
end
 +
 
 +
utilities.set_selected_modules (cfg); -- so that functions in Utilities can see the cfg tables
 +
identifiers.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in Identifiers can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
 +
validation.set_selected_modules (utilities); -- so that functions in Date validataion can see the selected Utilities module
 +
metadata.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities); -- so that functions in COinS can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
 +
 
 +
dates = validation.dates; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Date validation
 +
year_date_check = validation.year_date_check;
 +
reformat_dates = validation.reformat_dates;
 +
date_hyphen_to_dash = validation.date_hyphen_to_dash;
 +
 +
is_set = utilities.is_set; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 +
in_array = utilities.in_array;
 +
substitute = utilities.substitute;
 +
error_comment = utilities.error_comment;
 +
set_error = utilities.set_error;
 +
select_one = utilities.select_one;
 +
add_maint_cat = utilities.add_maint_cat;
 +
wrap_style = utilities.wrap_style;
 +
safe_for_italics = utilities.safe_for_italics;
 +
remove_wiki_link = utilities.remove_wiki_link;
 +
 
 +
z = utilities.z; -- table of error and category tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 +
 
 +
extract_ids = identifiers.extract_ids; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
 +
build_id_list = identifiers.build_id_list;
 +
is_embargoed = identifiers.is_embargoed;
 +
extract_id_access_levels = identifiers.extract_id_access_levels;
 +
 +
make_coins_title = metadata.make_coins_title; -- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
 +
get_coins_pages = metadata.get_coins_pages;
 +
COinS = metadata.COinS;
 +
 
 +
local args = {};
 +
local suggestions = {};
 +
local error_text, error_state;
 +
 
 +
local config = {};
 +
for k, v in pairs( frame.args ) do
 +
config[k] = v;
 +
args[k] = v;  
 +
end
 +
 
 +
local capture; -- the single supported capture when matching unknown parameters using patterns
 +
for k, v in pairs( pframe.args ) do
 +
if v ~= '' then
 +
if not validate( k ) then
 +
error_text = "";
 +
if type( k ) ~= 'string' then
 +
-- Exclude empty numbered parameters
 +
if v:match("%S+") ~= nil then
 +
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'text_ignored', {v}, true );
 +
end
 +
elseif validate( k:lower() ) then
 +
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, k:lower()}, true );
 +
else
 +
if nil == suggestions.suggestions then -- if this table is nil then we need to load it
 +
if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then -- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
 +
suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions/sandbox' ); -- use the sandbox version
 +
else
 +
suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions' ); -- use the live version
 +
end
 +
end
 +
for pattern, param in pairs (suggestions.patterns) do -- loop through the patterns to see if we can suggest a proper parameter
 +
capture = k:match (pattern); -- the whole match if no caputre in pattern else the capture if a match
 +
if capture then -- if the pattern matches
 +
param = substitute( param, capture ); -- add the capture to the suggested parameter (typically the enumerator)
 +
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, param}, true ); -- set the error message
 +
end
 +
end
 +
if not is_set (error_text) then -- couldn't match with a pattern, is there an expicit suggestion?
 +
if suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ] ~= nil then
 +
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ]}, true );
 +
else
 +
error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored', {k}, true );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
end  
 +
if error_text ~= '' then
 +
table.insert( z.message_tail, {error_text, error_state} );
 +
end
 +
end
 +
missing_pipe_check (v); -- do we think that there is a parameter that is missing a pipe?
 +
 +
args[k] = v;
 +
elseif args[k] ~= nil or (k == 'postscript') then
 +
args[k] = v;
 +
end
 +
end
 +
 
 +
for k, v in pairs( args ) do
 +
if 'string' == type (k) then -- don't evaluate positional parameters
 +
has_invisible_chars (k, v);
 +
end
 +
end
 +
return citation0( config, args)
 
end
 
end
  
return z
+
return cs1;
---------------------------------------------------------------------
 
--NOTES
 
--
 
-- NOTE A1: This Lua module was originally designed to handle a mix
 
--      of citation styles, crossing Vancouver style with Wikipedia's
 
--      local Citation Style 1 (CS1) from {Template:Citation/core}.
 
--      However, the conflicting positions of parameters, scattered
 
--      in twisted locations across this module, led to a separate
 
--      variation just to untangle the CS1 format of citations.
 
--
 
-- NOTE D2: The placement of dots and other separators between the
 
--      displayed parameters has been a continual headache, to keep
 
--      coordinated with the data in parentheses "(data)". There
 
--      has been a need to pre-check for the existence of related
 
--      options, to keep from putting double-dots ".." in some cases.
 
--      In particular, the omission of the "title=" parameter has led
 
--      to several cases of a spurious dot ". ." because the original
 
--      design had treated the title as a mandatory parameter.
 
--
 
------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
--HISTORY:
 
--18Oct2012 Fixed lead-space in Chapter by omitting " ".
 
--18Oct2012 Fixed lead-space in Chapter/Title as end " " of Authors/Date/...
 
--19Oct2012 Put HISTORY comments to log major changes (not typos).
 
--19Oct2012 Fixed extra dot ".." in Title by omitting at end of "tcommon=...".
 
--19Oct2012 For pages, put &nbsp in "p.&nbsp;" etc.
 
--19Oct2012 Enhanced "pages=" to detect lone page as "p." else "pp." prefix.
 
--19Oct2012 Fixed to show "." after Periodical name (work, newspaper...).
 
--19Oct2012 Fixed web-link to have spaces "[...  Archived] from the original".
 
--19Oct2012 Fixed to show ";" between authors & coauthors.
 
--19Oct2012 Fixed to omit extra "." after coauthors.
 
--20Oct2012 Fixed COinS data to not urlencode all, as "ctx_ver=Z39.88-2004"
 
--20Oct2012 Fixed COinS to not end as "&" but use lead "&rft...=" form.
 
--20Oct2012 Fixed COinS to not url.encode page's "rfr_id=..." pagename.
 
--20Oct2012 Fixed COinS data when "web" to default to rft.genre "book".
 
--05Nov2012 Add a span wrapper even when there is no Ref parameter
 
--15Feb2013 Added Agency for "agency=xx".
 
--19Feb2013 Put NOTES comments to explain module operation.
 
--19Feb2013 Copied as Module:Citation/CS1 to alter to match wp:CS1 form.
 
--19Feb2013 Changed OrigYear to use [__] for CS1 style.
 
--19Feb2013 Fixed to not show duplicate Publisher/Agency.
 
--19Feb2013 Moved page-number parameters to after final date.
 
--19Feb2013 Fixed to not put double-dots after title again.
 
--20Feb2013 Changed to omit dot "." if already ends with dot.
 
--20Feb2013 If class "journal" shows Publisher after Periodical/Series.
 
--20Feb2013 Shifted Format to after Language, and Others after Volume.
 
--20Feb2013 Set AccessDate + <span class="reference-accessdate">
 
--20Feb2013 Fixed url when deadurl=no.
 
--20Feb2013 Added sepc for separator character between parameters.
 
--20Feb2013 Put "OCLC" for "Online Computer Library Center".
 
--20Feb2013 Fix empty "authorlink=" as person.link ~= "".
 
--20Feb2013 Added space after AuthorSep & AuthorNameSep.
 
--21Feb2013 Added args.contributor (was missing parameter).
 
--21Feb2013 Fixed EditorSep (was misspelled "EdithorSep").
 
--21Feb2013 Set OCinSdata.rft_val_fmt = "info:ofi/fmt:kev:mtx:book"
 
--21Feb2013 Checked to omit blank codes (asin= | doi= etc.).
 
--21Feb2013 Set enddot to end line if not config.CitationClass "citation".
 
--21Feb2013 Fixed to show "issn=x" as the ISSN code.
 
--21Feb2013 Fixed to show "id=x" after Zbl code.
 
--21Feb2013 Changed to omit double-dot before date when already dot.
 
--21Feb2013 Order config.CitationClass "citation": Volume, Issue, Publisher.
 
--21Feb2013 Put warning "Bad DOI (expected "10."..)" in DOI result.
 
--21Feb2013 Automatically unbolded volume+comma when > 4 long.
 
--21Feb2013 Changed to allow lowercase "asin-tld".
 
--22Feb2013 Fixed ref=harv to extract Year from Date.
 
--22Feb2013 Set Harvard refer. span id if config.CitationClass "citation".
 
--22Feb2013 Fixed config.CitationClass "citation" as span class="citation".
 
--22Feb2013 Capitalized "Archived/Retrieved" only when sepc is dot ".".
 
--23Feb2013 Fixed author editor for "in" or "In" and put space after sepc.
 
--23Feb2013 Changed to omit dot in "et al." when sepc is "." separator.
 
--23Feb2013 Fixed "author1-first" to also get args.given or args.given1.
 
--23Feb2013 Fixed args.article to set Title, after Periodical is Title.
 
--23Feb2013 Fixed to allow blank Title (such as "contribution=mytitle").
 
--23Feb2013 Fixed double-dot ".." at end of Editors list
 
--26Feb2013 Moved "issue=" data to show before "page=".
 
--26Feb2013 Moved "type=" data to show after "format=".
 
--26Feb2013 For "pmc=" link, omitted suffix "/?tool=pmcentrez".
 
--27Feb2013 For coauthors, omitted extra separator after authors.
 
--27Feb2013 For date, allowed empty date to use month/day/year.
 
--27Feb2013 Fixed double-dot ".." at end of authors/coauthors list.
 
--27Feb2013 Reset editor suffix as ", ed." when date exists.
 
--27Feb2013 Removed duplicate display of "others=" data.
 
--27Feb2013 Removed parentheses "( )" around "department" TitleNote.
 
--05Mar2013 Moved Language to follow Periodical or Series.
 
--05Mar2013 Fixed Edition to follow Series or Volume.
 
--05Mar2013 Fixed class encyclopaedia to show article as quoted Chapter.
 
--05Mar2013 Fixed class encyclopaedia to show page as "pp." or "p.".
 
--07Mar2013 Changed class encyclopaedia to omit "( )" around publisher.
 
--07Mar2013 Fixed end double-dot by string.sub(idcommon,-1,-1) was "-1,1".
 
--13Mar2013 Removed enddot "." after "quote=" parameter.
 
--13Mar2013 Changed config.CitationClass "news" to use "p." page format.
 
--13Mar2013 Fixed missing "location=" when "web" or "encyclopaedia".
 
--14Mar2013 Fixed end double-dot after book/work title.
 
--14Mar2013 Fixed double-dot before "p." or "pp." page number.
 
--14Mar2013 Fixed config.CitationClass "book" to use p./pp. page.
 
--
 
--End
 

Latest revision as of 00:52, 29 October 2016

Documentation for this module may be created at Module:Citation/CS1/doc


local cs1 ={};

--[[--------------------------< F O R W A R D   D E C L A R A T I O N S >--------------------------------------
]]

local dates, year_date_check, reformat_dates, date_hyphen_to_dash				-- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation

local is_set, in_array, substitute, error_comment, set_error, select_one,		-- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
	add_maint_cat, wrap_style, safe_for_italics, remove_wiki_link;

local z ={};																	-- tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities

local extract_ids, extract_id_access_levels, build_id_list, is_embargoed;					-- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers

local make_coins_title, get_coins_pages, COinS;									-- functions in Module:Citation/CS1/COinS

local cfg = {};																	-- table of configuration tables that are defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration
local whitelist = {};															-- table of tables listing valid template parameter names; defined in Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist


--[[--------------------------< P A G E   S C O P E   V A R I A B L E S >--------------------------------------

delare variables here that have page-wide scope that are not brought in from other modules; thatare created here
and used here

]]

local added_deprecated_cat;														-- boolean flag so that the category is added only once
local added_prop_cats = {};														-- list of property categories that have been added to z.properties_cats
local added_vanc_errs;															-- boolean flag so we only emit one Vancouver error / category

local Frame;																	-- holds the module's frame table


--[[--------------------------< F I R S T _ S E T >------------------------------------------------------------

Locates and returns the first set value in a table of values where the order established in the table,
left-to-right (or top-to-bottom), is the order in which the values are evaluated.  Returns nil if none are set.

This version replaces the original 'for _, val in pairs do' and a similar version that used ipairs.  With the pairs
version the order of evaluation could not be guaranteed.  With the ipairs version, a nil value would terminate
the for-loop before it reached the actual end of the list.

]]

local function first_set (list, count)
	local i = 1;
	while i <= count do															-- loop through all items in list
		if is_set( list[i] ) then
			return list[i];														-- return the first set list member
		end
		i = i + 1;																-- point to next
	end
end

--[[--------------------------< A D D _ P R O P _ C A T >--------------------------------------------------------

Adds a category to z.properties_cats using names from the configuration file with additional text if any.

added_prop_cats is a table declared in page scope variables above

]]

local function add_prop_cat (key, arguments)
	if not added_prop_cats [key] then
		added_prop_cats [key] = true;											-- note that we've added this category
		table.insert( z.properties_cats, substitute (cfg.prop_cats [key], arguments));		-- make name then add to table
	end
end

--[[--------------------------< A D D _ V A N C _ E R R O R >----------------------------------------------------

Adds a single Vancouver system error message to the template's output regardless of how many error actually exist.
To prevent duplication, added_vanc_errs is nil until an error message is emitted.

added_vanc_errs is a boolean declared in page scope variables above

]]

local function add_vanc_error (source)
	if not added_vanc_errs then
		added_vanc_errs = true;													-- note that we've added this category
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'vancouver', {source}, true ) } );
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< I S _ S C H E M E >------------------------------------------------------------

does this thing that purports to be a uri scheme seem to be a valid scheme?  The scheme is checked to see if it
is in agreement with http://tools.ietf.org/html/std66#section-3.1 which says:
	Scheme names consist of a sequence of characters beginning with a
   letter and followed by any combination of letters, digits, plus
   ("+"), period ("."), or hyphen ("-").

returns true if it does, else false

]]

local function is_scheme (scheme)
	return scheme and scheme:match ('^%a[%a%d%+%.%-]*:');						-- true if scheme is set and matches the pattern
end


--[=[-------------------------< I S _ D O M A I N _ N A M E >--------------------------------------------------

Does this thing that purports to be a domain name seem to be a valid domain name?

Syntax defined here: http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc1034#section-3.5
BNF defined here: https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4234
Single character names are generally reserved; see https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-dnsind-iana-dns-01#page-15;
	see also [[Single-letter second-level domain]]
list of tlds: https://www.iana.org/domains/root/db

rfc952 (modified by rfc 1123) requires the first and last character of a hostname to be a letter or a digit.  Between
the first and last characters the name may use letters, digits, and the hyphen.

Also allowed are IPv4 addresses. IPv6 not supported

domain is expected to be stripped of any path so that the last character in the last character of the tld.  tld
is two or more alpha characters.  Any preceding '//' (from splitting a url with a scheme) will be stripped
here.  Perhaps not necessary but retained incase it is necessary for IPv4 dot decimal.

There are several tests:
	the first character of the whole domain name including subdomains must be a letter or a digit
	internationalized domain name (ascii characters with .xn-- ASCII Compatible Encoding (ACE) prefix xn-- in the tld) see https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3490
	single-letter/digit second-level domains in the .org TLD
	q, x, and z SL domains in the .com TLD
	i and q SL domains in the .net TLD
	single-letter SL domains in the ccTLDs (where the ccTLD is two letters)
	two-character SL domains in gTLDs (where the gTLD is two or more letters)
	three-plus-character SL domains in gTLDs (where the gTLD is two or more letters)
	IPv4 dot-decimal address format; TLD not allowed

returns true if domain appears to be a proper name and tld or IPv4 address, else false

]=]

local function is_domain_name (domain)
	if not domain then
		return false;															-- if not set, abandon
	end
	
	domain = domain:gsub ('^//', '');											-- strip '//' from domain name if present; done here so we only have to do it once
	
	if not domain:match ('^[%a%d]') then										-- first character must be letter or digit
		return false;
	end
																				-- Do most common case first
	if domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then				-- three or more character hostname.hostname or hostname.tld
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d%-]+[%a%d]%.xn%-%-[%a%d]+$') then	-- internationalized domain name with ACE prefix
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.org$') then							-- one character .org hostname
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][qxz]%.com$') then								-- assigned one character .com hostname (x.com times out 2015-12-10)
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a][iq]%.net$') then								-- assigned one character .net hostname (q.net registered but not active 2015-12-10)
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a$') then							-- one character hostname and cctld (2 chars)
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('%f[%a%d][%a%d][%a%d]%.%a%a+$') then					-- two character hostname and tld
		return true;
	elseif domain:match ('^%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?%.%d%d?%d?') then		-- IPv4 address
		return true;
	else
		return false;
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< I S _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------------

returns true if the scheme and domain parts of a url appear to be a valid url; else false.

This function is the last step in the validation process.  This function is separate because there are cases that
are not covered by split_url(), for example is_parameter_ext_wikilink() which is looking for bracketted external
wikilinks.

]]

local function is_url (scheme, domain)
	if is_set (scheme) then														-- if scheme is set check it and domain
		return is_scheme (scheme) and is_domain_name (domain);
	else
		return is_domain_name (domain);											-- scheme not set when url is protocol relative
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< S P L I T _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------

Split a url into a scheme, authority indicator, and domain.

First remove Fully Qualified Domain Name terminator (a dot following tld) (if any) and any path(/), query(?) or fragment(#).

If protocol relative url, return nil scheme and domain else return nil for both scheme and domain.

When not protocol relative, get scheme, authority indicator, and domain.  If there is an authority indicator (one
or more '/' characters immediately following the scheme's colon), make sure that there are only 2.

Strip off any port and path;

]]

local function split_url (url_str)
	local scheme, authority, domain;
	
	url_str = url_str:gsub ('([%a%d])%.?[/%?#].*$', '%1');						-- strip FQDN terminator and path(/), query(?), fragment (#) (the capture prevents false replacement of '//')

	if url_str:match ('^//%S*') then											-- if there is what appears to be a protocol relative url
		domain = url_str:match ('^//(%S*)')
	elseif url_str:match ('%S-:/*%S+') then										-- if there is what appears to be a scheme, optional authority indicator, and domain name
		scheme, authority, domain = url_str:match ('(%S-:)(/*)(%S+)');			-- extract the scheme, authority indicator, and domain portions
		authority = authority:gsub ('//', '', 1);								-- replace place 1 pair of '/' with nothing;
		if is_set(authority) then												-- if anything left (1 or 3+ '/' where authority should be) then
			return scheme;														-- return scheme only making domain nil which will cause an error message
		end
		domain = domain:gsub ('(%a):%d+', '%1');								-- strip port number if present
	end
	
	return scheme, domain;
end


--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ P A R A M _ O K >---------------------------------------------------

checks the content of |title-link=, |series-link=, |author-link= etc for properly formatted content: no wikilinks, no urls

Link parameters are to hold the title of a wikipedia article so none of the WP:TITLESPECIALCHARACTERS are allowed:
	# < > [ ] | { } _
except the underscore which is used as a space in wiki urls and # which is used for section links

returns false when the value contains any of these characters.

When there are no illegal characters, this function returns TRUE if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url (the
|<param>-link= parameter is ok); else false when value appears to be a valid url (the |<param>-link= parameter is NOT ok).

]]

local function link_param_ok (value)
	local scheme, domain;
	if value:find ('[<>%[%]|{}]') then											-- if any prohibited characters
		return false;
	end

	scheme, domain = split_url (value);											-- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url; 
	return not is_url (scheme, domain);											-- return true if value DOES NOT appear to be a valid url
end

--[[--------------------------< L I N K _ T I T L E _ O K >---------------------------------------------------

Use link_param_ok() to validate |<param>-link= value and its matching |<title>= value.

|<title>= may be wikilinked but not when |<param>-link= has a value.  This function emits an error message when
that condition exists

]]

local function link_title_ok (link, lorig, title, torig)
local orig;

	if is_set (link) then 														-- don't bother if <param>-link doesn't have a value
		if not link_param_ok (link) then										-- check |<param>-link= markup
			orig = lorig;														-- identify the failing link parameter
		elseif title:find ('%[%[') then											-- check |title= for wikilink markup
			orig = torig;														-- identify the failing |title= parameter
		end
	end

	if is_set (orig) then
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_paramlink', orig)});	-- url or wikilink in |title= with |title-link=;
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< C H E C K _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------------

Determines whether a URL string appears to be valid.

First we test for space characters.  If any are found, return false.  Then split the url into scheme and domain
portions, or for protocol relative (//example.com) urls, just the domain.  Use is_url() to validate the two
portions of the url.  If both are valid, or for protocol relative if domain is valid, return true, else false.

Because it is different from a standard url, and because this module used external_link() to make external links
that work for standard and news: links, we validate newsgroup names here.  The specification for a newsgroup name
is at https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5536#section-3.1.4

]]

local function check_url( url_str )
	if nil == url_str:match ("^%S+$") then										-- if there are any spaces in |url=value it can't be a proper url
		return false;
	end
	local scheme, domain;

	scheme, domain = split_url (url_str);										-- get scheme or nil and domain or nil from url;
	
	if 'news:' == scheme then													-- special case for newsgroups
		return domain:match('^[%a%d%+%-_]+%.[%a%d%+%-_%.]*[%a%d%+%-_]$');
	end
	
	return is_url (scheme, domain);												-- return true if value appears to be a valid url
end


--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P A R A M E T E R _ E X T _ W I K I L I N K >----------------------------

Return true if a parameter value has a string that begins and ends with square brackets [ and ] and the first
non-space characters following the opening bracket appear to be a url.  The test will also find external wikilinks
that use protocol relative urls. Also finds bare urls.

The frontier pattern prevents a match on interwiki links which are similar to scheme:path urls.  The tests that
find bracketed urls are required because the parameters that call this test (currently |title=, |chapter=, |work=,
and |publisher=) may have wikilinks and there are articles or redirects like '//Hus' so, while uncommon, |title=[[//Hus]]
is possible as might be [[en://Hus]].

]=]

local function is_parameter_ext_wikilink (value)
local scheme, domain;

	if value:match ('%f[%[]%[%a%S*:%S+.*%]') then								-- if ext wikilink with scheme and domain: [xxxx://yyyyy.zzz]
		scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(%a%S*:%S+).*%]'));
	elseif value:match ('%f[%[]%[//%S+.*%]') then								-- if protocol relative ext wikilink: [//yyyyy.zzz]
		scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('%f[%[]%[(//%S+).*%]'));
	elseif value:match ('%a%S*:%S+') then										-- if bare url with scheme; may have leading or trailing plain text
		scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(%a%S*:%S+)'));
	elseif value:match ('//%S+') then											-- if protocol relative bare url: //yyyyy.zzz; may have leading or trailing plain text
		scheme, domain = split_url (value:match ('(//%S+)'));					-- what is left should be the domain
	else
		return false;															-- didn't find anything that is obviously a url
	end

	return is_url (scheme, domain);												-- return true if value appears to be a valid url
end


--[[-------------------------< C H E C K _ F O R _ U R L >-----------------------------------------------------

loop through a list of parameters and their values.  Look at the value and if it has an external link, emit an error message.

]]

local function check_for_url (parameter_list)
local error_message = '';
	for k, v in pairs (parameter_list) do										-- for each parameter in the list
		if is_parameter_ext_wikilink (v) then									-- look at the value; if there is a url add an error message
			if is_set(error_message) then										-- once we've added the first portion of the error message ...
				error_message=error_message .. ", ";							-- ... add a comma space separator
			end
			error_message=error_message .. "&#124;" .. k .. "=";				-- add the failed parameter
		end
	end
	if is_set (error_message) then												-- done looping, if there is an error message, display it
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_has_ext_link', {error_message}, true ) } );
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ F O R _ U R L >------------------------------------------------------

Escape sequences for content that will be used for URL descriptions

]]

local function safe_for_url( str )
	if str:match( "%[%[.-%]%]" ) ~= nil then 
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'wikilink_in_url', {}, true ) } );
	end
	
	return str:gsub( '[%[%]\n]', {	
		['['] = '&#91;',
		[']'] = '&#93;',
		['\n'] = ' ' } );
end

--[[--------------------------< E X T E R N A L _ L I N K >----------------------------------------------------

Format an external link with error checking

]]

local function external_link( URL, label, source, access)
	local error_str = "";
	local domain;
	local path;
	local base_url;
	
	if not is_set( label ) then
		label = URL;
		if is_set( source ) then
			error_str = set_error( 'bare_url_missing_title', { wrap_style ('parameter', source) }, false, " " );
		else
			error( cfg.messages["bare_url_no_origin"] );
		end			
	end
	if not check_url( URL ) then
		error_str = set_error( 'bad_url', {wrap_style ('parameter', source)}, false, " " ) .. error_str;
	end
	
	domain, path = URL:match ('^([/%.%-%+:%a%d]+)([/%?#].*)$');					-- split the url into scheme plus domain and path
	if path then																-- if there is a path portion
		path = path:gsub ('[%[%]]', {['[']='%5b',[']']='%5d'});					-- replace '[' and ']' with their percent encoded values
		URL=domain..path;														-- and reassemble
	end
	
	base_url = table.concat({ "[", URL, " ", safe_for_url( label ), "]" });
	
	if is_set(access) then -- access level (free, paywalled, ...)
		base_url = substitute(cfg.presentation[access], base_url);
	end
	
	return table.concat({ base_url, error_str });
end


--[[--------------------------< D E P R E C A T E D _ P A R A M E T E R >--------------------------------------

Categorize and emit an error message when the citation contains one or more deprecated parameters.  The function includes the
offending parameter name to the error message.  Only one error message is emitted regardless of the number of deprecated
parameters in the citation.

added_deprecated_cat is a boolean declared in page scope variables above

]]

local function deprecated_parameter(name)
	if not added_deprecated_cat then
		added_deprecated_cat = true;											-- note that we've added this category
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'deprecated_params', {name}, true ) } );		-- add error message
	end
end

--[[--------------------------< K E R N _ Q U O T E S >--------------------------------------------------------

Apply kerning to open the space between the quote mark provided by the Module and a leading or trailing quote mark contained in a |title= or |chapter= parameter's value.
This function will positive kern either single or double quotes:
	"'Unkerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks'"
	" 'Kerned title with leading and trailing single quote marks' " (in real life the kerning isn't as wide as this example)
Double single quotes (italic or bold wikimarkup) are not kerned.

Replaces unicode quotemarks with typewriter quote marks regardless of the need for kerning.

Call this function for chapter titles, for website titles, etc; not for book titles.

]]

local function kern_quotes (str)
	local cap='';
	local cap2='';
																				-- TODO: move this elswhere so that all title-holding elements get these quote marks replaced?
	str= mw.ustring.gsub (str, '[“”]', '\"');									-- replace “” (U+201C & U+201D) with " (typewriter double quote mark)
	str= mw.ustring.gsub (str, '[‘’]', '\'');									-- replace ‘’ (U+2018 & U+2019) with ' (typewriter single quote mark)
	
	cap, cap2 = str:match ("^([\"\'])([^\'].+)");								-- match leading double or single quote but not double single quotes
	if is_set (cap) then
		str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-left'], {cap, cap2});
	end

	cap, cap2 = str:match ("^(.+[^\'])([\"\'])$")
	if is_set (cap) then
		str = substitute (cfg.presentation['kern-right'], {cap, cap2});
	end
	return str;
end

--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ S C R I P T _ V A L U E >----------------------------------------

|script-title= holds title parameters that are not written in Latin based scripts: Chinese, Japanese, Arabic, Hebrew, etc. These scripts should
not be italicized and may be written right-to-left.  The value supplied by |script-title= is concatenated onto Title after Title has been wrapped
in italic markup.

Regardless of language, all values provided by |script-title= are wrapped in <bdi>...</bdi> tags to isolate rtl languages from the English left to right.

|script-title= provides a unique feature.  The value in |script-title= may be prefixed with a two-character ISO639-1 language code and a colon:
	|script-title=ja:*** *** (where * represents a Japanese character)
Spaces between the two-character code and the colon and the colon and the first script character are allowed:
	|script-title=ja : *** ***
	|script-title=ja: *** ***
	|script-title=ja :*** ***
Spaces preceding the prefix are allowed: |script-title = ja:*** ***

The prefix is checked for validity.  If it is a valid ISO639-1 language code, the lang attribute (lang="ja") is added to the <bdi> tag so that browsers can
know the language the tag contains.  This may help the browser render the script more correctly.  If the prefix is invalid, the lang attribute
is not added.  At this time there is no error message for this condition.

Supports |script-title= and |script-chapter=

TODO: error messages when prefix is invalid ISO639-1 code; when script_value has prefix but no script;
]]

local function format_script_value (script_value)
	local lang='';																-- initialize to empty string
	local name;
	if script_value:match('^%l%l%s*:') then										-- if first 3 non-space characters are script language prefix
		lang = script_value:match('^(%l%l)%s*:%s*%S.*');						-- get the language prefix or nil if there is no script
		if not is_set (lang) then
			return '';															-- script_value was just the prefix so return empty string
		end
																				-- if we get this far we have prefix and script
		name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang, "en" );						-- get language name so that we can use it to categorize
		if is_set (name) then													-- is prefix a proper ISO 639-1 language code?
			script_value = script_value:gsub ('^%l%l%s*:%s*', '');				-- strip prefix from script
																				-- is prefix one of these language codes?
			if in_array (lang, cfg.script_lang_codes) then
				add_prop_cat ('script_with_name', {name, lang})
			else
				add_prop_cat ('script')
			end
			lang = ' lang="' .. lang .. '" ';									-- convert prefix into a lang attribute
		else
			lang = '';															-- invalid so set lang to empty string
		end
	end
	script_value = substitute (cfg.presentation['bdi'], {lang, script_value});	-- isolate in case script is rtl

	return script_value;
end

--[[--------------------------< S C R I P T _ C O N C A T E N A T E >------------------------------------------

Initially for |title= and |script-title=, this function concatenates those two parameter values after the script value has been 
wrapped in <bdi> tags.
]]

local function script_concatenate (title, script)
	if is_set (script) then
		script = format_script_value (script);									-- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; returns empty string on error
		if is_set (script) then
			title = title .. ' ' .. script;										-- concatenate title and script title
		end
	end
	return title;
end


--[[--------------------------< W R A P _ M S G >--------------------------------------------------------------

Applies additional message text to various parameter values. Supplied string is wrapped using a message_list
configuration taking one argument.  Supports lower case text for {{citation}} templates.  Additional text taken
from citation_config.messages - the reason this function is similar to but separate from wrap_style().

]]

local function wrap_msg (key, str, lower)
	if not is_set( str ) then
		return "";
	end
	if true == lower then
		local msg;
		msg = cfg.messages[key]:lower();										-- set the message to lower case before 
		return substitute( msg, str );										-- including template text
	else
		return substitute( cfg.messages[key], str );
	end		
end


--[[--------------------------< F O R M A T _ C H A P T E R _ T I T L E >--------------------------------------

Format the four chapter parameters: |script-chapter=, |chapter=, |trans-chapter=, and |chapter-url= into a single Chapter meta-
parameter (chapter_url_source used for error messages).

]]

local function format_chapter_title (scriptchapter, chapter, transchapter, chapterurl, chapter_url_source, no_quotes)
	local chapter_error = '';
	
	if not is_set (chapter) then
		chapter = '';															-- to be safe for concatenation
	else
		if false == no_quotes then
			chapter = kern_quotes (chapter);										-- if necessary, separate chapter title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
			chapter = wrap_style ('quoted-title', chapter);
		end
	end

	chapter = script_concatenate (chapter, scriptchapter)						-- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped

	if is_set (transchapter) then
		transchapter = wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', transchapter);
		if is_set (chapter) then
			chapter = chapter ..  ' ' .. transchapter;
		else																	-- here when transchapter without chapter or script-chapter
			chapter = transchapter;												-- 
			chapter_error = ' ' .. set_error ('trans_missing_title', {'chapter'});
		end
	end

	if is_set (chapterurl) then
		chapter = external_link (chapterurl, chapter, chapter_url_source, nil);		-- adds bare_url_missing_title error if appropriate
	end

	return chapter .. chapter_error;
end

--[[--------------------------< H A S _ I N V I S I B L E _ C H A R S >----------------------------------------

This function searches a parameter's value for nonprintable or invisible characters.  The search stops at the
first match.

This function will detect the visible replacement character when it is part of the wikisource.

Detects but ignores nowiki and math stripmarkers.  Also detects other named stripmarkers (gallery, math, pre, ref)
and identifies them with a slightly different error message.  See also coins_cleanup().

Detects but ignores the character pattern that results from the transclusion of {{'}} templates.

Output of this function is an error message that identifies the character or the Unicode group, or the stripmarker
that was detected along with its position (or, for multi-byte characters, the position of its first byte) in the
parameter value.

]]

local function has_invisible_chars (param, v)
	local position = '';														-- position of invisible char or starting position of stripmarker
	local dummy;																-- end of matching string; not used but required to hold end position when a capture is returned
	local capture;																-- used by stripmarker detection to hold name of the stripmarker
	local i=1;
	local stripmarker, apostrophe;
	
	capture = string.match (v, '[%w%p ]*');										-- Test for values that are simple ASCII text and bypass other tests if true
	if capture == v then														-- if same there are no unicode characters
		return;
	end

	while cfg.invisible_chars[i] do
		local char=cfg.invisible_chars[i][1]									-- the character or group name
		local pattern=cfg.invisible_chars[i][2]									-- the pattern used to find it
		position, dummy, capture = mw.ustring.find (v, pattern)					-- see if the parameter value contains characters that match the pattern
		
		if position then
			if 'nowiki' == capture or 'math' == capture then 					-- nowiki, math stripmarker (not an error condition)
				stripmarker = true;												-- set a flag
			elseif true == stripmarker and 'delete' == char then				-- because stripmakers begin and end with the delete char, assume that we've found one end of a stripmarker
				position = nil;													-- unset
			else
				local err_msg;
				if capture then
					err_msg = capture .. ' ' .. char;
				else
					err_msg = char .. ' ' .. 'character';
				end

				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invisible_char', {err_msg, wrap_style ('parameter', param), position}, true ) } );	-- add error message
				return;															-- and done with this parameter
			end
		end
		i=i+1;																	-- bump our index
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< A R G U M E N T _ W R A P P E R >----------------------------------------------

Argument wrapper.  This function provides support for argument mapping defined in the configuration file so that
multiple names can be transparently aliased to single internal variable.

]]

local function argument_wrapper( args )
	local origin = {};
	
	return setmetatable({
		ORIGIN = function( self, k )
			local dummy = self[k]; --force the variable to be loaded.
			return origin[k];
		end
	},
	{
		__index = function ( tbl, k )
			if origin[k] ~= nil then
				return nil;
			end
			
			local args, list, v = args, cfg.aliases[k];
			
			if type( list ) == 'table' then
				v, origin[k] = select_one( args, list, 'redundant_parameters' );
				if origin[k] == nil then
					origin[k] = ''; -- Empty string, not nil
				end
			elseif list ~= nil then
				v, origin[k] = args[list], list;
			else
				-- maybe let through instead of raising an error?
				-- v, origin[k] = args[k], k;
				error( cfg.messages['unknown_argument_map'] );
			end
			
			-- Empty strings, not nil;
			if v == nil then
				v = cfg.defaults[k] or '';
				origin[k] = '';
			end
			
			tbl = rawset( tbl, k, v );
			return v;
		end,
	});
end

--[[--------------------------< V A L I D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------------
Looks for a parameter's name in the whitelist.

Parameters in the whitelist can have three values:
	true - active, supported parameters
	false - deprecated, supported parameters
	nil - unsupported parameters
	
]]

local function validate( name )
	local name = tostring( name );
	local state = whitelist.basic_arguments[ name ];
	
	-- Normal arguments
	if true == state then return true; end		-- valid actively supported parameter
	if false == state then
		deprecated_parameter (name);				-- parameter is deprecated but still supported
		return true;
	end
	
	-- Arguments with numbers in them
	name = name:gsub( "%d+", "#" );				-- replace digit(s) with # (last25 becomes last#
	state = whitelist.numbered_arguments[ name ];
	if true == state then return true; end		-- valid actively supported parameter
	if false == state then
		deprecated_parameter (name);				-- parameter is deprecated but still supported
		return true;
	end
	
	return false;								-- Not supported because not found or name is set to nil
end


--[[--------------------------< N O W R A P _ D A T E >--------------------------------------------------------

When date is YYYY-MM-DD format wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>YYYY-MM-DD</span>.  When date is DD MMMM YYYY or is
MMMM DD, YYYY then wrap in nowrap span: <span ...>DD MMMM</span> YYYY or <span ...>MMMM DD,</span> YYYY

DOES NOT yet support MMMM YYYY or any of the date ranges.

]]

local function nowrap_date (date)
	local cap='';
	local cap2='';

	if date:match("^%d%d%d%d%-%d%d%-%d%d$") then
		date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap1'], date);
	
	elseif date:match("^%a+%s*%d%d?,%s+%d%d%d%d$") or date:match ("^%d%d?%s*%a+%s+%d%d%d%d$") then
		cap, cap2 = string.match (date, "^(.*)%s+(%d%d%d%d)$");
		date = substitute (cfg.presentation['nowrap2'], {cap, cap2});
	end
	
	return date;
end

--[[--------------------------< S E T _ T I T L E T Y P E >----------------------------------------------------

This function sets default title types (equivalent to the citation including |type=<default value>) for those templates that have defaults.
Also handles the special case where it is desirable to omit the title type from the rendered citation (|type=none).

]]

local function set_titletype (cite_class, title_type)
	if is_set(title_type) then
		if "none" == title_type then
			title_type = "";													-- if |type=none then type parameter not displayed
		end
		return title_type;														-- if |type= has been set to any other value use that value
	end

	return cfg.title_types [cite_class] or '';									-- set template's default title type; else empty string for concatenation
end


--[[--------------------------< H Y P H E N _ T O _ D A S H >--------------------------------------------------

Converts a hyphen to a dash

]]

local function hyphen_to_dash( str )
	if not is_set(str) or str:match( "[%[%]{}<>]" ) ~= nil then
		return str;
	end	
	return str:gsub( '-', '–' );
end


--[[--------------------------< S A F E _ J O I N >------------------------------------------------------------

Joins a sequence of strings together while checking for duplicate separation characters.

]]

local function safe_join( tbl, duplicate_char )
	--[[
	Note: we use string functions here, rather than ustring functions.
	
	This has considerably faster performance and should work correctly as 
	long as the duplicate_char is strict ASCII.  The strings
	in tbl may be ASCII or UTF8.
	]]
	
	local str = '';																-- the output string
	local comp = '';															-- what does 'comp' mean?
	local end_chr = '';
	local trim;
	for _, value in ipairs( tbl ) do
		if value == nil then value = ''; end
		
		if str == '' then														-- if output string is empty
			str = value;														-- assign value to it (first time through the loop)
		elseif value ~= '' then
			if value:sub(1,1) == '<' then										-- Special case of values enclosed in spans and other markup.
				comp = value:gsub( "%b<>", "" );								-- remove html markup (<span>string</span> -> string)
			else
				comp = value;
			end
																				-- typically duplicate_char is sepc
			if comp:sub(1,1) == duplicate_char then								-- is first charactier same as duplicate_char? why test first character?
																				--   Because individual string segments often (always?) begin with terminal punct for th
																				--   preceding segment: 'First element' .. 'sepc next element' .. etc?
				trim = false;
				end_chr = str:sub(-1,-1);										-- get the last character of the output string
				-- str = str .. "<HERE(enchr=" .. end_chr.. ")"					-- debug stuff?
				if end_chr == duplicate_char then								-- if same as separator
					str = str:sub(1,-2);										-- remove it
				elseif end_chr == "'" then										-- if it might be wikimarkup
					if str:sub(-3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "''" then			-- if last three chars of str are sepc'' 
						str = str:sub(1, -4) .. "''";							-- remove them and add back ''
					elseif str:sub(-5,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]''" then		-- if last five chars of str are sepc]]'' 
						trim = true;											-- why? why do this and next differently from previous?
					elseif str:sub(-4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]''" then		-- if last four chars of str are sepc]'' 
						trim = true;											-- same question
					end
				elseif end_chr == "]" then										-- if it might be wikimarkup
					if str:sub(-3,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]]" then			-- if last three chars of str are sepc]] wikilink 
						trim = true;
					elseif str:sub(-2,-1) == duplicate_char .. "]" then			-- if last two chars of str are sepc] external link
						trim = true;
					elseif str:sub(-4,-1) == duplicate_char .. "'']" then		-- normal case when |url=something & |title=Title.
						trim = true;
					end
				elseif end_chr == " " then										-- if last char of output string is a space
					if str:sub(-2,-1) == duplicate_char .. " " then				-- if last two chars of str are <sepc><space>
						str = str:sub(1,-3);									-- remove them both
					end
				end

				if trim then
					if value ~= comp then 										-- value does not equal comp when value contains html markup
						local dup2 = duplicate_char;
						if dup2:match( "%A" ) then dup2 = "%" .. dup2; end		-- if duplicate_char not a letter then escape it
						
						value = value:gsub( "(%b<>)" .. dup2, "%1", 1 )			-- remove duplicate_char if it follows html markup
					else
						value = value:sub( 2, -1 );								-- remove duplicate_char when it is first character
					end
				end
			end
			str = str .. value;													--add it to the output string
		end
	end
	return str;
end  


--[[--------------------------< I S _ S U F F I X >------------------------------------------------------------

returns true is suffix is properly formed Jr, Sr, or ordinal in the range 2–9.  Puncutation not allowed.

]]

local function is_suffix (suffix)
	if in_array (suffix, {'Jr', 'Sr', '2nd', '3rd'}) or suffix:match ('^%dth$') then
		return true;
	end
	return false;
end

--[[--------------------------< I S _ G O O D _ V A N C _ N A M E >--------------------------------------------

For Vancouver Style, author/editor names are supposed to be rendered in Latin (read ASCII) characters.  When a name
uses characters that contain diacritical marks, those characters are to converted to the corresponding Latin character.
When a name is written using a non-Latin alphabet or logogram, that name is to be transliterated into Latin characters.
These things are not currently possible in this module so are left to the editor to do.

This test allows |first= and |last= names to contain any of the letters defined in the four Unicode Latin character sets
	[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0000.pdf C0 Controls and Basic Latin] 0041–005A, 0061–007A
	[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0080.pdf C1 Controls and Latin-1 Supplement] 00C0–00D6, 00D8–00F6, 00F8–00FF
	[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0100.pdf Latin Extended-A] 0100–017F
	[http://www.unicode.org/charts/PDF/U0180.pdf Latin Extended-B] 0180–01BF, 01C4–024F

|lastn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, and apostrophes. (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
|firstn= also allowed to contain hyphens, spaces, apostrophes, and periods

This original test:
	if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%']*$") or nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-zÀ-ÖØ-öø-ƿDŽ-ɏ%-%s%'%.]+[2-6%a]*$") then
was written ouside of the code editor and pasted here because the code editor gets confused between character insertion point and cursor position.
The test has been rewritten to use decimal character escape sequence for the individual bytes of the unicode characters so that it is not necessary
to use an external editor to maintain this code.

	\195\128-\195\150 – À-Ö (U+00C0–U+00D6 – C0 controls)
	\195\152-\195\182 – Ø-ö (U+00D8-U+00F6 – C0 controls)
	\195\184-\198\191 – ø-ƿ (U+00F8-U+01BF – C0 controls, Latin extended A & B)
	\199\132-\201\143 – DŽ-ɏ (U+01C4-U+024F – Latin extended B)

]]

local function is_good_vanc_name (last, first)
	local first, suffix = first:match ('(.-),?%s*([%dJS][%drndth]+)%.?$') or first;		-- if first has something that looks like a generational suffix, get it

	if is_set (suffix) then
		if not is_suffix (suffix) then
			add_vanc_error ('suffix');
			return false;														-- not a name with an appropriate suffix
		end
	end
	if nil == mw.ustring.find (last, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%']*$") or
		nil == mw.ustring.find (first, "^[A-Za-z\195\128-\195\150\195\152-\195\182\195\184-\198\191\199\132-\201\143%-%s%'%.]*$") then
			add_vanc_error ('non-Latin character');
			return false;														-- not a string of latin characters; Vancouver requires Romanization
	end;
	return true;
end

--[[--------------------------< R E D U C E _ T O _ I N I T I A L S >------------------------------------------

Attempts to convert names to initials in support of |name-list-format=vanc.  

Names in |firstn= may be separated by spaces or hyphens, or for initials, a period. See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35062/.

Vancouver style requires family rank designations (Jr, II, III, etc) to be rendered as Jr, 2nd, 3rd, etc.  See http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35085/.
This code only accepts and understands generational suffix in the Vancouver format because Roman numerals look like, and can be mistaken for, initials.

This function uses ustring functions because firstname initials may be any of the unicode Latin characters accepted by is_good_vanc_name ().

]]

local function reduce_to_initials(first)
	local name, suffix = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+) ([%dJS][%drndth]+)$");

	if not name then															-- if not initials and a suffix
		name = mw.ustring.match(first, "^(%u+)$");								-- is it just intials?
	end

	if name then																-- if first is initials with or without suffix
		if 3 > name:len() then													-- if one or two initials
			if suffix then														-- if there is a suffix
				if is_suffix (suffix) then										-- is it legitimate?
					return first;												-- one or two initials and a valid suffix so nothing to do
				else
					add_vanc_error ('suffix');									-- one or two initials with invalid suffix so error message
					return first;												-- and return first unmolested
				end
			else
				return first;													-- one or two initials without suffix; nothing to do
			end
		end
	end																			-- if here then name has 3 or more uppercase letters so treat them as a word


	local initials, names = {}, {};												-- tables to hold name parts and initials
	local i = 1;																-- counter for number of initials

	names = mw.text.split (first, '[%s,]+');									-- split into a table of names and possible suffix

	while names[i] do															-- loop through the table
		if 1 < i and names[i]:match ('[%dJS][%drndth]+%.?$') then				-- if not the first name, and looks like a suffix (may have trailing dot)
			names[i] = names[i]:gsub ('%.', '');								-- remove terminal dot if present
			if is_suffix (names[i]) then										-- if a legitimate suffix
				table.insert (initials, ' ' .. names[i]);						-- add a separator space, insert at end of initials table
				break;															-- and done because suffix must fall at the end of a name
			end																	-- no error message if not a suffix; possibly because of Romanization
		end
		if 3 > i then
			table.insert (initials, mw.ustring.sub(names[i],1,1));				-- insert the intial at end of initials table
		end
		i = i+1;																-- bump the counter
	end
			
	return table.concat(initials)												-- Vancouver format does not include spaces.
end

--[[--------------------------< L I S T  _ P E O P L E >-------------------------------------------------------

Formats a list of people (e.g. authors / editors) 

]]

local function list_people(control, people, etal)
	local sep;
	local namesep;
	local format = control.format
	local maximum = control.maximum
	local lastauthoramp = control.lastauthoramp;
	local text = {}

	if 'vanc' == format then													-- Vancouver-like author/editor name styling?
		sep = ',';																-- name-list separator between authors is a comma
		namesep = ' ';															-- last/first separator is a space
	elseif 'mla' == control.mode then
		sep = ',';																-- name-list separator between authors is a comma
		namesep = ', '															-- last/first separator is <comma><space>
	else
		sep = ';'																-- name-list separator between authors is a semicolon
		namesep = ', '															-- last/first separator is <comma><space>
	end
	
	if sep:sub(-1,-1) ~= " " then sep = sep .. " " end
	if is_set (maximum) and maximum < 1 then return "", 0; end					-- returned 0 is for EditorCount; not used for authors
	
	for i,person in ipairs(people) do
		if is_set(person.last) then
			local mask = person.mask
			local one
			local sep_one = sep;
			if is_set (maximum) and i > maximum then
				etal = true;
				break;
			elseif (mask ~= nil) then
				local n = tonumber(mask)
				if (n ~= nil) then
					one = string.rep("&mdash;",n)
				else
					one = mask;
					sep_one = " ";
				end
			else
				one = person.last
				local first = person.first
				if is_set(first) then
					if 'mla' == control.mode then 
						if i == 1 then											-- for mla
							one = one .. namesep .. first;						-- first name last, first
						else													-- all other names
							one = first .. ' ' .. one;							-- first last
						end
					else
						if ( "vanc" == format ) then								-- if vancouver format
							one = one:gsub ('%.', '');								-- remove periods from surnames (http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/books/NBK7271/box/A35029/)
							if not person.corporate and is_good_vanc_name (one, first) then					-- and name is all Latin characters; corporate authors not tested
								first = reduce_to_initials(first)					-- attempt to convert first name(s) to initials
							end
						end
						one = one .. namesep .. first;
					end
				end
				if is_set(person.link) and person.link ~= control.page_name then
					one = "[[" .. person.link .. "|" .. one .. "]]"				-- link author/editor if this page is not the author's/editor's page
				end
			end
			table.insert( text, one )
			table.insert( text, sep_one )
		end
	end

	local count = #text / 2;													-- (number of names + number of separators) divided by 2
	if count > 0 then 
		if count > 1 and is_set(lastauthoramp) and not etal then
			if 'mla' == control.mode then
				text[#text-2] = ", and ";										-- replace last separator with ', and ' text
			else
				text[#text-2] = " & ";											-- replace last separator with ampersand text
			end
		end
		text[#text] = nil;														-- erase the last separator
	end
	
	local result = table.concat(text)											-- construct list
	if etal and is_set (result) then											-- etal may be set by |display-authors=etal but we might not have a last-first list
		result = result .. sep .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al'];					-- we've go a last-first list and etal so add et al.
	end
	
	return result, count
end

--[[--------------------------< A N C H O R _ I D >------------------------------------------------------------

Generates a CITEREF anchor ID if we have at least one name or a date.  Otherwise returns an empty string.

namelist is one of the contributor-, author-, or editor-name lists chosen in that order.  year is Year or anchor_year.

]]
local function anchor_id (namelist, year)
	local names={};																-- a table for the one to four names and year
	for i,v in ipairs (namelist) do												-- loop through the list and take up to the first four last names
		names[i] = v.last 
		if i == 4 then break end												-- if four then done
	end
	table.insert (names, year);													-- add the year at the end
	local id = table.concat(names);												-- concatenate names and year for CITEREF id
	if is_set (id) then															-- if concatenation is not an empty string
		return "CITEREF" .. id;													-- add the CITEREF portion
	else
		return '';																-- return an empty string; no reason to include CITEREF id in this citation
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ E T A L >----------------------------------------------------

Evaluates the content of author and editor name parameters for variations on the theme of et al.  If found,
the et al. is removed, a flag is set to true and the function returns the modified name and the flag.

This function never sets the flag to false but returns it's previous state because it may have been set by
previous passes through this function or by the parameters |display-authors=etal or |display-editors=etal

]]

local function name_has_etal (name, etal, nocat)

	if is_set (name) then														-- name can be nil in which case just return
		local etal_pattern = "[;,]? *[\"']*%f[%a][Ee][Tt] *[Aa][Ll][%.\"']*$"	-- variations on the 'et al' theme
		local others_pattern = "[;,]? *%f[%a]and [Oo]thers";					-- and alternate to et al.
		
		if name:match (etal_pattern) then										-- variants on et al.
			name = name:gsub (etal_pattern, '');								-- if found, remove
			etal = true;														-- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
			if not nocat then													-- no categorization for |vauthors=
				add_maint_cat ('etal');											-- and add a category if not already added
			end
		elseif name:match (others_pattern) then									-- if not 'et al.', then 'and others'?
			name = name:gsub (others_pattern, '');								-- if found, remove
			etal = true;														-- set flag (may have been set previously here or by |display-authors=etal)
			if not nocat then													-- no categorization for |vauthors=
				add_maint_cat ('etal');											-- and add a category if not already added
			end
		end
	end
	return name, etal;															-- 
end

--[[--------------------------< N A M E _ H A S _ M U L T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------

Evaluates the content of author and editor (surnames only) parameters for multiple names.  Multiple names are
indicated if there is more than one comma and or semicolon.  If found, the function adds the multiple name
(author or editor) maintenance category.

]]

local function name_has_mult_names (name, list_name)
local count, _;
	if is_set (name) then
		if name:match ('^%(%(.*%)%)$') then										-- if wrapped in doubled parentheses, ignore 
			name = name:match ('^%(%((.*)%)%)$');								-- strip parens
		else
			_, count = name:gsub ('[;,]', '');									-- count the number of separator-like characters
			
			if 1 < count then													-- param could be |author= or |editor= so one separactor character is acceptable
				add_maint_cat ('mult_names', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]);	-- more than one separator indicates multiple names so add a maint cat for this template
			end
		end
	end
	return name;																-- and done
end

--[[--------------------------< E X T R A C T _ N A M E S >----------------------------------------------------
Gets name list from the input arguments

Searches through args in sequential order to find |lastn= and |firstn= parameters (or their aliases), and their matching link and mask parameters.
Stops searching when both |lastn= and |firstn= are not found in args after two sequential attempts: found |last1=, |last2=, and |last3= but doesn't
find |last4= and |last5= then the search is done.

This function emits an error message when there is a |firstn= without a matching |lastn=.  When there are 'holes' in the list of last names, |last1= and |last3=
are present but |last2= is missing, an error message is emitted. |lastn= is not required to have a matching |firstn=.

When an author or editor parameter contains some form of 'et al.', the 'et al.' is stripped from the parameter and a flag (etal) returned
that will cause list_people() to add the static 'et al.' text from Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration.  This keeps 'et al.' out of the 
template's metadata.  When this occurs, the page is added to a maintenance category.

]]

local function extract_names(args, list_name)
	local names = {};			-- table of names
	local last;					-- individual name components
	local first;
	local link;
	local mask;
	local i = 1;				-- loop counter/indexer
	local n = 1;				-- output table indexer
	local count = 0;			-- used to count the number of times we haven't found a |last= (or alias for authors, |editor-last or alias for editors)
	local etal=false;			-- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. in an author parameter

	local err_msg_list_name = list_name:match ("(%w+)List") .. 's list';		-- modify AuthorList or EditorList for use in error messages if necessary
	while true do
		last = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', i );		-- search through args for name components beginning at 1
		first = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
		link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
		mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );

		last, etal = name_has_etal (last, etal, false);							-- find and remove variations on et al.
		first, etal = name_has_etal (first, etal, false);						-- find and remove variations on et al.
--		last = name_has_mult_names (last, err_msg_list_name);					-- check for multiple names in last and its aliases
		last = name_has_mult_names (last, list_name);					-- check for multiple names in last and its aliases
		
		if first and not last then												-- if there is a firstn without a matching lastn
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'first_missing_last', {err_msg_list_name, i}, true ) } );	-- add this error message
		elseif not first and not last then										-- if both firstn and lastn aren't found, are we done?
			count = count + 1;													-- number of times we haven't found last and first
			if 2 <= count then													-- two missing names and we give up
				break;															-- normal exit or there is a two-name hole in the list; can't tell which
			end
		else																	-- we have last with or without a first
			link_title_ok (link, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-link' .. i, last, list_name:match ("(%w+)List"):lower() .. '-last' .. i);	-- check for improper wikimarkup

			names[n] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=false};	-- add this name to our names list (corporate for |vauthors= only)
			n = n + 1;															-- point to next location in the names table
			if 1 == count then													-- if the previous name was missing
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'missing_name', {err_msg_list_name, i-1}, true ) } );		-- add this error message
			end
			count = 0;															-- reset the counter, we're looking for two consecutive missing names
		end
		i = i + 1;																-- point to next args location
	end
	
	return names, etal;															-- all done, return our list of names
end

--[[--------------------------< G E T _ I S O 6 3 9 _ C O D E >------------------------------------------------

Validates language names provided in |language= parameter if not an ISO639-1 or 639-2 code.

Returns the language name and associated two- or three-character code.  Because case of the source may be incorrect
or different from the case that WikiMedia uses, the name comparisons are done in lower case and when a match is
found, the Wikimedia version (assumed to be correct) is returned along with the code.  When there is no match, we
return the original language name string.

mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(<local wiki language>, 'all') return a list of languages that in some cases may include
extensions. For example, code 'cbk-zam' and its associated name 'Chavacano de Zamboanga' (MediaWiki does not support
code 'cbk' or name 'Chavacano'.

Names but that are included in the list will be found if that name is provided in the |language= parameter.  For example,
if |language=Chavacano de Zamboanga, that name will be found with the associated code 'cbk-zam'.  When names are found
and the associated code is not two or three characters, this function returns only the Wikimedia language name.

Adapted from code taken from Module:Check ISO 639-1.

]]

local function get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code)
	local languages = mw.language.fetchLanguageNames(this_wiki_code, 'all')		-- get a list of language names known to Wikimedia
																				-- ('all' is required for North Ndebele, South Ndebele, and Ojibwa)
	local langlc = mw.ustring.lower(lang);										-- lower case version for comparisons
	
	for code, name in pairs(languages) do										-- scan the list to see if we can find our language
		if langlc == mw.ustring.lower(name) then
			if 2 ~= code:len() and 3 ~= code:len() then							-- two- or three-character codes only; extensions not supported
				return name;													-- so return the name but not the code
			end
			return name, code;													-- found it, return name to ensure proper capitalization and the the code
		end
	end
	return lang;																-- not valid language; return language in original case and nil for the code
end

--[[--------------------------< L A N G U A G E _ P A R A M E T E R >------------------------------------------

Gets language name from a provided two- or three-character ISO 639 code.  If a code is recognized by MediaWiki,
use the returned name; if not, then use the value that was provided with the language parameter.

When |language= contains a recognized language (either code or name), the page is assigned to the category for
that code: Category:Norwegian-language sources (no).  For valid three-character code languages, the page is assigned
to the single category for '639-2' codes: Category:CS1 ISO 639-2 language sources.

Languages that are the same as the local wiki are not categorized.  MediaWiki does not recognize three-character
equivalents of two-character codes: code 'ar' is recognized bit code 'ara' is not.

This function supports multiple languages in the form |language=nb, French, th where the language names or codes are
separated from each other by commas.

]]

local function language_parameter (lang)
	local code;																	-- the two- or three-character language code
	local name;																	-- the language name
	local language_list = {};													-- table of language names to be rendered
	local names_table = {};														-- table made from the value assigned to |language=

	local this_wiki = mw.getContentLanguage();									-- get a language object for this wiki
	local this_wiki_code = this_wiki:getCode()									-- get this wiki's language code
	local this_wiki_name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName(this_wiki_code, this_wiki_code);	-- get this wiki's language name

	names_table = mw.text.split (lang, '%s*,%s*');								-- names should be a comma separated list

	for _, lang in ipairs (names_table) do										-- reuse lang

		if lang:match ('^%a%a%-') then											-- strip ietf language tags from code; TODO: is there a need to support 3-char with tag?
			lang = lang:match ('(%a%a)%-')										-- keep only 639-1 code portion to lang; TODO: do something with 3166 alpha 2 country code?
		end
		if 2 == lang:len() or 3 == lang:len() then								-- if two-or three-character code
			name = mw.language.fetchLanguageName( lang:lower(), this_wiki_code);	-- get language name if |language= is a proper code
		end
	
		if is_set (name) then													-- if |language= specified a valid code
			code = lang:lower();												-- save it
		else
			name, code = get_iso639_code (lang, this_wiki_code);				-- attempt to get code from name (assign name here so that we are sure of proper capitalization)
		end
	
		if is_set (code) then													-- only 2- or 3-character codes
			if this_wiki_code ~= code then										-- when the language is not the same as this wiki's language
				if 2 == code:len() then											-- and is a two-character code
					add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source', {name, code})			-- categorize it
				else															-- or is a recognized language (but has a three-character code)
					add_prop_cat ('foreign_lang_source_2', {code})				-- categorize it differently TODO: support mutliple three-character code categories per cs1|2 template
				end
			end
		else
			add_maint_cat ('unknown_lang');										-- add maint category if not already added
		end
		
		table.insert (language_list, name);
		name = '';																-- so we can reuse it
	end
	
	code = #language_list														-- reuse code as number of languages in the list
	if 2 >= code then
		name = table.concat (language_list, ' and ')							-- insert '<space>and<space>' between two language names
	elseif 2 < code then
		language_list[code] = 'and ' .. language_list[code];					-- prepend last name with 'and<space>'
		name = table.concat (language_list, ', ')								-- and concatenate with '<comma><space>' separators
	end
	if this_wiki_name == name then
		return '';																-- if one language and that language is this wiki's return an empty string (no annotation)
	end
	return (" " .. wrap_msg ('language', name));								-- otherwise wrap with '(in ...)'
	--[[ TODO: should only return blank or name rather than full list
	so we can clean up the bunched parenthetical elements Language, Type, Format
	]]
end

--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 1 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------

Set style settings for CS1 citation templates. Returns separator and postscript settings

]]

local function set_cs1_style (ps)
	if not is_set (ps) then														-- unless explicitely set to something
		ps = '.';																-- terminate the rendered citation with a period
	end
	return '.', ps;																-- separator is a full stop
end

--[[--------------------------< S E T _ C S 2 _ S T Y L E >----------------------------------------------------

Set style settings for CS2 citation templates. Returns separator, postscript, ref settings

]]

local function set_cs2_style (ps, ref)
	if not is_set (ps) then														-- if |postscript= has not been set, set cs2 default
		ps = '';																-- make sure it isn't nil
	end
	if not is_set (ref) then													-- if |ref= is not set
		ref = "harv";															-- set default |ref=harv
	end
	return ',', ps, ref;														-- separator is a comma
end

--[[--------------------------< G E T _ S E T T I N G S _ F R O M _ C I T E _ C L A S S >----------------------

When |mode= is not set or when its value is invalid, use config.CitationClass and parameter values to establish
rendered style.

]]

local function get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class)
	local sep;
	if (cite_class == "citation") then											-- for citation templates (CS2)
		sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
	else																		-- not a citation template so CS1
		sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
	end

	return sep, ps, ref															-- return them all
end

--[[--------------------------< S E T _ S T Y L E >------------------------------------------------------------

Establish basic style settings to be used when rendering the citation.  Uses |mode= if set and valid or uses
config.CitationClass from the template's #invoke: to establish style.

]]

local function set_style (mode, ps, ref, cite_class)
	local sep;
	if 'cs2' == mode then														-- if this template is to be rendered in CS2 (citation) style
		sep, ps, ref = set_cs2_style (ps, ref);
	elseif 'cs1' == mode then													-- if this template is to be rendered in CS1 (cite xxx) style
		sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
	elseif 'mla' == mode then													-- if this template is to be rendered in mla style use cs1 for bot cs1 & cs2 templates
		sep, ps = set_cs1_style (ps);
	else																		-- anything but cs1 or cs2
		sep, ps, ref = get_settings_from_cite_class (ps, ref, cite_class);		-- get settings based on the template's CitationClass
	end
	if 'none' == ps:lower() then												-- if assigned value is 'none' then
		ps = '';																-- set to empty string
	end
	
	return sep, ps, ref
end

--[=[-------------------------< I S _ P D F >------------------------------------------------------------------

Determines if a url has the file extension that is one of the pdf file extensions used by [[MediaWiki:Common.css]] when
applying the pdf icon to external links.

returns true if file extension is one of the recognized extension, else false

]=]

local function is_pdf (url)
	return url:match ('%.pdf[%?#]?') or url:match ('%.PDF[%?#]?');
end

--[[--------------------------< S T Y L E _ F O R M A T >------------------------------------------------------

Applies css style to |format=, |chapter-format=, etc.  Also emits an error message if the format parameter does
not have a matching url parameter.  If the format parameter is not set and the url contains a file extension that
is recognized as a pdf document by MediaWiki's commons.css, this code will set the format parameter to (PDF) with
the appropriate styling.

]]

local function style_format (format, url, fmt_param, url_param)
	if is_set (format) then
		format = wrap_style ('format', format);									-- add leading space, parenthases, resize
		if not is_set (url) then
			format = format .. set_error( 'format_missing_url', {fmt_param, url_param} );	-- add an error message
		end
	elseif is_pdf (url) then													-- format is not set so if url is a pdf file then
		format = wrap_style ('format', 'PDF');									-- set format to pdf
	else
		format = '';															-- empty string for concatenation
	end
	return format;
end

--[[--------------------------< G E T _ D I S P L A Y _ A U T H O R S _ E D I T O R S >------------------------

Returns a number that defines the number of names displayed for author and editor name lists and a boolean flag
to indicate when et al. should be appended to the name list.

When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is a number greater than or equal to zero, return the number and
the previous state of the 'etal' flag (false by default but may have been set to true if the name list contains
some variant of the text 'et al.').

When the value assigned to |display-xxxxors= is the keyword 'etal', return a number that is one greater than the
number of authors in the list and set the 'etal' flag true.  This will cause the list_people() to display all of
the names in the name list followed by 'et al.'

In all other cases, returns nil and the previous state of the 'etal' flag.

inputs:
	max: A['DisplayAuthors'] or A['DisplayEditors']; a number or some flavor of etal
	count: #a or #e
	list_name: 'authors' or 'editors'
	etal: author_etal or editor_etal

]]

local function get_display_authors_editors (max, count, list_name, etal)
	if is_set (max) then
		if 'etal' == max:lower():gsub("[ '%.]", '') then						-- the :gsub() portion makes 'etal' from a variety of 'et al.' spellings and stylings
			max = count + 1;													-- number of authors + 1 so display all author name plus et al.
			etal = true;														-- overrides value set by extract_names()
		elseif max:match ('^%d+$') then											-- if is a string of numbers
			max = tonumber (max);												-- make it a number
			if max >= count then												-- if |display-xxxxors= value greater than or equal to number of authors/editors
				add_maint_cat ('disp_auth_ed', cfg.special_case_translation [list_name]);
			end
		else																	-- not a valid keyword or number
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {'display-' .. list_name, max}, true ) } );		-- add error message
			max = nil;															-- unset; as if |display-xxxxors= had not been set
		end
	end
	
	return max, etal;
end

--[[--------------------------< E X T R A _ T E X T _ I N _ P A G E _ C H E C K >------------------------------

Adds page to Category:CS1 maint: extra text if |page= or |pages= has what appears to be some form of p. or pp. 
abbreviation in the first characters of the parameter content.

check Page and Pages for extraneous p, p., pp, and pp. at start of parameter value:
	good pattern: '^P[^%.P%l]' matches when |page(s)= begins PX or P# but not Px where x and X are letters and # is a dgiit
	bad pattern: '^[Pp][Pp]' matches matches when |page(s)= begins pp or pP or Pp or PP

]]

local function extra_text_in_page_check (page)
--	local good_pattern = '^P[^%.P%l]';
	local good_pattern = '^P[^%.Pp]';											-- ok to begin with uppercase P: P7 (pg 7 of section P) but not p123 (page 123) TODO: add Gg for PG or Pg?
--	local bad_pattern = '^[Pp][Pp]';
	local bad_pattern = '^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]';

	if not page:match (good_pattern) and (page:match (bad_pattern) or  page:match ('^[Pp]ages?')) then
		add_maint_cat ('extra_text');
	end
--		if Page:match ('^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]') or  Page:match ('^[Pp]ages?[ %d]') or
--			Pages:match ('^[Pp]?[Pp]%.?[ %d]') or  Pages:match ('^[Pp]ages?[ %d]') then
--				add_maint_cat ('extra_text');
--		end
end

--[[--------------------------< G E T _ V _ N A M E _ T A B L E >----------------------------------------------

split apart a |vautthors= or |veditors= parameter.  This function allows for corporate names, wrapped in doubled
parentheses to also have commas; in the old version of the code, the doubled parnetheses were included in the
rendered citation and in the metadata.

	|vauthors=Jones AB, White EB, ((Black, Brown, and Co.))

This code is experimental and may not be retained.

]]
local function get_v_name_table (vparam, output_table)
	local name_table = mw.text.split(vparam, "%s*,%s*");						-- names are separated by commas
	
	local i = 1;
	
	while name_table[i] do
		if name_table[i]:match ('^%(%(.*[^%)][^%)]$') then						-- first segment of corporate with one or more commas; this segment has the opening doubled parens
			local name = name_table[i];
			i=i+1;																-- bump indexer to next segment
			while name_table[i] do
				name = name .. ', ' .. name_table[i];							-- concatenate with previous segments
				if name_table[i]:match ('^.*%)%)$') then						-- if this table member has the closing doubled parens
					break;														-- and done reassembling so
				end
				i=i+1;															-- bump indexer
			end
			table.insert (output_table, name);									-- and add corporate name to the output table
		else
			table.insert (output_table, name_table[i]);							-- add this name 
		end
		i = i+1;
	end	
	return output_table;
end

--[[--------------------------< P A R S E _ V A U T H O R S _ V E D I T O R S >--------------------------------

This function extracts author / editor names from |vauthors= or |veditors= and finds matching |xxxxor-maskn= and
|xxxxor-linkn= in args.  It then returns a table of assembled names just as extract_names() does.

Author / editor names in |vauthors= or |veditors= must be in Vancouver system style. Corporate or institutional names
may sometimes be required and because such names will often fail the is_good_vanc_name() and other format compliance
tests, are wrapped in doubled paranethese ((corporate name)) to suppress the format tests.

Supports generational suffixes Jr, 2nd, 3rd, 4th–6th.

This function sets the vancouver error when a reqired comma is missing and when there is a space between an author's initials.

]]

local function parse_vauthors_veditors (args, vparam, list_name)
	local names = {};															-- table of names assembled from |vauthors=, |author-maskn=, |author-linkn=
	local v_name_table = {};
	local etal = false;															-- return value set to true when we find some form of et al. vauthors parameter
	local last, first, link, mask, suffix;
	local corporate = false;

	vparam, etal = name_has_etal (vparam, etal, true);							-- find and remove variations on et al. do not categorize (do it here because et al. might have a period)
	if vparam:find ('%[%[') or vparam:find ('%]%]')	then						-- no wikilinking vauthors names
		add_vanc_error ('wikilink');
	end
	v_name_table = get_v_name_table (vparam, v_name_table);						-- names are separated by commas

	for i, v_name in ipairs(v_name_table) do
		if v_name:match ('^%(%(.+%)%)$') then									-- corporate authors are wrapped in doubled parentheses to supress vanc formatting and error detection
			first = '';															-- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
			last = v_name:match ('^%(%((.+)%)%)$')								-- remove doubled parntheses
			corporate = true;													-- flag used in list_people()
		elseif string.find(v_name, "%s") then
			if v_name:find('[;%.]') then										-- look for commonly occurring punctuation characters; 
				add_vanc_error ('punctuation');
			end
			local lastfirstTable = {}
			lastfirstTable = mw.text.split(v_name, "%s")
			first = table.remove(lastfirstTable);								-- removes and returns value of last element in table which should be author intials
			if is_suffix (first) then											-- if a valid suffix
				suffix = first													-- save it as a suffix and
				first = table.remove(lastfirstTable);							-- get what should be the initials from the table
			end																	-- no suffix error message here because letter combination may be result of Romanization; check for digits?
			last = table.concat(lastfirstTable, " ")							-- returns a string that is the concatenation of all other names that are not initials
			if mw.ustring.match (last, '%a+%s+%u+%s+%a+') then
				add_vanc_error ('missing comma');								-- matches last II last; the case when a comma is missing
			end
			if mw.ustring.match (v_name, ' %u %u$') then						-- this test is in the wrong place TODO: move or replace with a more appropriate test
				add_vanc_error ('name');										-- matches a space between two intiials
			end
		else
			first = '';															-- set to empty string for concatenation and because it may have been set for previous author/editor
			last = v_name;														-- last name or single corporate name?  Doesn't support multiword corporate names? do we need this?
		end
																
		if is_set (first) then
			if not mw.ustring.match (first, "^%u?%u$") then						-- first shall contain one or two upper-case letters, nothing else
				add_vanc_error ('initials');									-- too many initials; mixed case initials (which may be ok Romanization); hyphenated initials
			end
			is_good_vanc_name (last, first);									-- check first and last before restoring the suffix which may have a non-Latin digit
			if is_set (suffix) then
				first = first .. ' ' .. suffix;									-- if there was a suffix concatenate with the initials
				suffix = '';													-- unset so we don't add this suffix to all subsequent names
			end
		else
			if not corporate then
				is_good_vanc_name (last, '');
			end
		end
																				-- this from extract_names ()
		link = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Link'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
		mask = select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Mask'], 'redundant_parameters', i );
		names[i] = {last = last, first = first, link = link, mask = mask, corporate=corporate};		-- add this assembled name to our names list
	end
	return names, etal;															-- all done, return our list of names
end


--[[--------------------------< S E L E C T _ A U T H O R _ E D I T O R _ S O U R C E >------------------------

Select one of |authors=, |authorn= / |lastn / firstn=, or |vauthors= as the source of the author name list or
select one of |editors=, |editorn= / editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= or |veditors= as the source of the editor name list.

Only one of these appropriate three will be used.  The hierarchy is: |authorn= (and aliases) highest and |authors= lowest and
similarly, |editorn= (and aliases) highest and |editors= lowest

When looking for |authorn= / |editorn= parameters, test |xxxxor1= and |xxxxor2= (and all of their aliases); stops after the second
test which mimicks the test used in extract_names() when looking for a hole in the author name list.  There may be a better
way to do this, I just haven't discovered what that way is.

Emits an error message when more than one xxxxor name source is provided.

In this function, vxxxxors = vauthors or veditors; xxxxors = authors or editors as appropriate.

]]

local function select_author_editor_source (vxxxxors, xxxxors, args, list_name)
local lastfirst = false;
	if select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 1 ) or		-- do this twice incase we have a |first1= without a |last1=; this ...
		select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 1 ) or	-- ... also catches the case where |first= is used with |vauthors=
		select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-Last'], 'none', 2 ) or
		select_one( args, cfg.aliases[list_name .. '-First'], 'none', 2 ) then
			lastfirst=true;
	end

	if (is_set (vxxxxors) and true == lastfirst) or								-- these are the three error conditions
		(is_set (vxxxxors) and is_set (xxxxors)) or
		(true == lastfirst and is_set (xxxxors)) then
			local err_name;
			if 'AuthorList' == list_name then									-- figure out which name should be used in error message
				err_name = 'author';
			else
				err_name = 'editor';
			end
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters',
				{err_name .. '-name-list parameters'}, true ) } );				-- add error message
	end

	if true == lastfirst then return 1 end;										-- return a number indicating which author name source to use
	if is_set (vxxxxors) then return 2 end;
	if is_set (xxxxors) then return 3 end;
	return 1;																	-- no authors so return 1; this allows missing author name test to run in case there is a first without last 
end


--[[--------------------------< I S _ V A L I D _ P A R A M E T E R _ V A L U E >------------------------------

This function is used to validate a parameter's assigned value for those parameters that have only a limited number
of allowable values (yes, y, true, no, etc).  When the parameter value has not been assigned a value (missing or empty
in the source template) the function refurns true.  If the parameter value is one of the list of allowed values returns
true; else, emits an error message and returns false.

]]

local function is_valid_parameter_value (value, name, possible, cite_class)
-- begin hack to limit |mode=mla to a specific set of templates
	if ('mode' == name) and ('mla' == value) and not in_array (cite_class, {'book', 'journal', 'news'}) then
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {name, value}, true ) } );	-- not an allowed value so add error message
		return false
	end
-- end hack

	if not is_set (value) then
		return true;															-- an empty parameter is ok
	elseif in_array(value:lower(), possible) then
		return true;
	else
		table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'invalid_param_val', {name, value}, true ) } );	-- not an allowed value so add error message
		return false
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< T E R M I N A T E _ N A M E _ L I S T >----------------------------------------

This function terminates a name list (author, contributor, editor) with a separator character (sepc) and a space
when the last character is not a sepc character or when the last three characters are not sepc followed by two
closing square brackets (close of a wikilink).  When either of these is true, the name_list is terminated with a
single space character.

]]

local function terminate_name_list (name_list, sepc)
	if (string.sub (name_list,-1,-1) == sepc) or (string.sub (name_list,-3,-1) == sepc .. ']]') then	-- if last name in list ends with sepc char
		return name_list .. " ";												-- don't add another
	else
		return name_list .. sepc .. ' ';										-- otherwise terninate the name list
	end
end


--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ V O L U M E _ I S S U E >----------------------------------------

returns the concatenation of the formatted volume and issue parameters as a single string; or formatted volume
or formatted issue, or an empty string if neither are set.

]]
	
local function format_volume_issue (volume, issue, cite_class, origin, sepc, lower, mode)
	if not is_set (volume) and not is_set (issue) then
		return '';
	end
	
	if ('mla' == mode) and ('journal' == cite_class) then						-- same as cs1 for magazines
		lower = true;															-- mla 8th edition; force these to lower case
		if is_set (volume) and is_set (issue) then
			return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, volume, issue}, lower);
		elseif is_set (volume) then
			return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, volume}, lower);
		else
			return '';
		end
	end

	if 'magazine' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map'}) and 'magazine' == origin) then
		if is_set (volume) and is_set (issue) then
			return wrap_msg ('vol-no', {sepc, volume, issue}, lower);
		elseif is_set (volume) then
			return wrap_msg ('vol', {sepc, volume}, lower);
		else
			return wrap_msg ('issue', {sepc, issue}, lower);
		end
	end

	local vol = '';
		
	if is_set (volume) then
		if (4 < mw.ustring.len(volume)) then
			vol = substitute (cfg.messages['j-vol'], {sepc, volume});
		else
			vol = substitute (cfg.presentation['vol-bold'], {sepc, hyphen_to_dash(volume)});
		end
	end
	if is_set (issue) then
		return vol .. substitute (cfg.messages['j-issue'], issue);
	end
	return vol;
end


--[[-------------------------< N O R M A L I Z E _ P A G E _ L I S T >-----------------------------------------

not currently used

normalizes a comma, ampersand, and/or space separated list to be '<value>, <value>, ..., <value>'
returns list unchanged if there are no commas else strips whitespace and then reformats the list

]]
--[[
local function normalize_page_list (list)
	if not list:find ('[,& ]') then return list end								-- if list is not delimited with commas, ampersands, or spaces; done
	
	list = mw.text.split (list, '[,&%s]+');										-- make a table of values
	list = table.concat (list, ', ');											-- and now make a normalized list
	return list;
end
]]


--[[-------------------------< F O R M A T _ P A G E S _ S H E E T S >-----------------------------------------

adds static text to one of |page(s)= or |sheet(s)= values and returns it with all of the others set to empty strings.
The return order is:
	page, pages, sheet, sheets

Singular has priority over plural when both are provided.

]]

local function format_pages_sheets (page, pages, sheet, sheets, cite_class, origin, sepc, nopp, lower, mode)
	if 'map' == cite_class then													-- only cite map supports sheet(s) as in-source locators
		if is_set (sheet) then
			if 'journal' == origin then
				return '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheet', sheet, lower), '';
			else
				return '', '', wrap_msg ('sheet', {sepc, sheet}, lower), '';
			end
		elseif is_set (sheets) then
			if 'journal' == origin then
				return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('j-sheets', sheets, lower);
			else
				return '', '', '', wrap_msg ('sheets', {sepc, sheets}, lower);
			end
		end
	end

	local is_journal = 'journal' == cite_class or (in_array (cite_class, {'citation', 'map'}) and 'journal' == origin);
	
	if is_journal and 'mla' == mode then
		is_journal = false;														-- mla always uses p & pp
	end

	if is_set (page) then
		if is_journal then
			return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], page), '', '', '';
		elseif not nopp then
			return substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
		else
			return substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, page}), '', '', '';
		end
	elseif is_set(pages) then
		if is_journal then
			return substitute (cfg.messages['j-page(s)'], pages), '', '', '';
		elseif tonumber(pages) ~= nil and not nopp then										-- if pages is only digits, assume a single page number
			return '', substitute (cfg.messages['p-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
		elseif not nopp then
			return '', substitute (cfg.messages['pp-prefix'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
		else
			return '', substitute (cfg.messages['nopp'], {sepc, pages}), '', '';
		end
	end
	
	return '', '', '', '';														-- return empty strings
end


--[=[-------------------------< A R C H I V E _ U R L _ C H E C K >--------------------------------------------

Check archive.org urls to make sure they at least look like they are pointing at valid archives and not to the 
save snapshot url or to calendar pages.  When the archive url is 'https://web.archive.org/save/' (or http://...)
archive.org saves a snapshot of the target page in the url.  That is something that Wikipedia should not allow
unwitting readers to do.

When the archive.org url does not have a complete timestamp, archive.org chooses a snapshot according to its own
algorithm or provides a calendar 'search' result.  [[WP:ELNO]] discourages links to search results.

This function looks at the value assigned to |archive-url= and returns empty strings for |archive-url= and
|archive-date= and an error message when:
	|archive-url= holds an archive.org save command url
	|archive-url= is an archive.org url that does not have a complete timestamp (YYYYMMDDhhmmss 14 digits) in the
		correct place
otherwise returns |archive-url= and |archive-date=

There are two mostly compatible archive.org urls:
	//web.archive.org/<timestamp>...		-- the old form
	//web.archive.org/web/<timestamp>...	-- the new form

The old form does not support or map to the new form when it contains a display flag.  There are four identified flags
('id_', 'js_', 'cs_', 'im_') but since archive.org ignores others following the same form (two letters and an underscore)
we don't check for these specific flags but we do check the form.

This function supports a preview mode.  When the article is rendered in preview mode, this funct may return a modified
archive url:
	for save command errors, return undated wildcard (/*/)
	for timestamp errors when the timestamp has a wildcard, return the url unmodified
	for timestamp errors when the timestamp does not have a wildcard, return with timestamp limited to six digits plus wildcard (/yyyymm*/)

]=]

local function archive_url_check (url, date)
	local err_msg = '';															-- start with the error message empty
	local path, timestamp, flag;												-- portions of the archive.or url
	
	if not url:match('//web%.archive%.org/') then
		return url, date;														-- not an archive.org archive, return ArchiveURL and ArchiveDate
	end

	if url:match('//web%.archive%.org/save/') then								-- if a save command url, we don't want to allow saving of the target page 
		err_msg = 'save command';
		url = url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org)/save/', '%1/*/', 1);				-- for preview mode: modify ArchiveURL
	else
		path, timestamp, flag = url:match('//web%.archive%.org/([^%d]*)(%d+)([^/]*)/');		-- split out some of the url parts for evaluation
		
		if not is_set(timestamp) or 14 ~= timestamp:len() then					-- path and flag optional, must have 14-digit timestamp here
			err_msg = 'timestamp';
			if '*' ~= flag then
				url=url:gsub ('(//web%.archive%.org/[^%d]*%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?%d?)[^/]*', '%1*', 1)	-- for preview, modify ts to be yearmo* max (0-6 digits plus splat)
			end
		elseif is_set(path) and 'web/' ~= path then								-- older archive urls do not have the extra 'web/' path element
			err_msg = 'path';
		elseif is_set (flag) and not is_set (path) then							-- flag not allowed with the old form url (without the 'web/' path element)
			err_msg = 'flag';
		elseif is_set (flag) and not flag:match ('%a%a_') then					-- flag if present must be two alpha characters and underscore (requires 'web/' path element)
			err_msg = 'flag';
		else
			return url, date;													-- return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
		end
	end
																				-- if here, something not right so
	table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'archive_url', {err_msg}, true ) } );	-- add error message and
	if is_set (Frame:preprocess('{{REVISIONID}}')) then
		return '', '';															-- return empty strings for archiveURL and ArchiveDate
	else
		return url, date;														-- preview mode so return archiveURL and ArchiveDate
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< M I S S I N G _ P I P E _ C H E C K >------------------------------------------

Look at the contents of a parameter. If the content has a string of characters and digits followed by an equal
sign, compare the alphanumeric string to the list of cs1|2 parameters.  If found, then the string is possibly a
parameter that is missing its pipe:
	{{cite ... |title=Title access-date=2016-03-17}}

cs1|2 shares some parameter names with xml/html atributes: class=, title=, etc.  To prevent false positives xml/html
tags are removed before the search.

If a missing pipe is detected, this function adds the missing pipe maintenance category.

]]

local function missing_pipe_check (value)
	local capture;
	value = value:gsub ('%b<>', '');											-- remove xml/html tags because attributes: class=, title=, etc 

	capture = value:match ('%s+(%a[%a%d]+)%s*=') or value:match ('^(%a[%a%d]+)%s*=');	-- find and categorize parameters with possible missing pipes
	if capture and validate (capture) then								-- if the capture is a valid parameter name
		add_maint_cat ('missing_pipe');
	end
end


--[[--------------------------< C I T A T I O N 0 >------------------------------------------------------------

This is the main function doing the majority of the citation formatting.

]]

local function citation0( config, args)
	--[[ 
	Load Input Parameters
	The argument_wrapper facilitates the mapping of multiple aliases to single internal variable.
	]]
	local A = argument_wrapper( args );
	local i 

	-- Pick out the relevant fields from the arguments.  Different citation templates
	-- define different field names for the same underlying things.	

-- set default parameter values defined by |mode= parameter.  If |mode= is empty or omitted, use CitationClass to set these values
	local Mode = A['Mode'];
	if not is_valid_parameter_value (Mode, 'mode', cfg.keywords['mode'], config.CitationClass) then
		Mode = '';
	end

	local author_etal;
	local a	= {};																-- authors list from |lastn= / |firstn= pairs or |vauthors=
	local Authors;
	local NameListFormat = A['NameListFormat'];
	local Collaboration = A['Collaboration'];

	do																			-- to limit scope of selected
		local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Vauthors'], A['Authors'], args, 'AuthorList');
		if 1 == selected then
			a, author_etal = extract_names (args, 'AuthorList');				-- fetch author list from |authorn= / |lastn= / |firstn=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
		elseif 2 == selected then
			NameListFormat = 'vanc';											-- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
			a, author_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.vauthors, 'AuthorList');	-- fetch author list from |vauthors=, |author-linkn=, and |author-maskn=
		elseif 3 == selected then
			Authors = A['Authors'];												-- use content of |authors=
			if 'authors' == A:ORIGIN('Authors') then							-- but add a maint cat if the parameter is |authors=
				add_maint_cat ('authors');										-- because use of this parameter is discouraged; what to do about the aliases is a TODO:
			end
		end
		if is_set (Collaboration) then
			author_etal = true;													-- so that |display-authors=etal not required
		end
	end

	local Coauthors = A['Coauthors'];
	local Others = A['Others'];

	local editor_etal;
	local e	= {};																-- editors list from |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn= pairs or |veditors=
	local Editors;

	do																			-- to limit scope of selected
		local selected = select_author_editor_source (A['Veditors'], A['Editors'], args, 'EditorList');
		if 1 == selected then
			e, editor_etal = extract_names (args, 'EditorList');				-- fetch editor list from |editorn= / |editor-lastn= / |editor-firstn=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
		elseif 2 == selected then
			NameListFormat = 'vanc';											-- override whatever |name-list-format= might be
			e, editor_etal = parse_vauthors_veditors (args, args.veditors, 'EditorList');	-- fetch editor list from |veditors=, |editor-linkn=, and |editor-maskn=
		elseif 3 == selected then
			Editors = A['Editors'];												-- use content of |editors=
			add_maint_cat ('editors');											-- but add a maint cat because use of this parameter is discouraged
		end
	end

	local t = {};																-- translators list from |translator-lastn= / translator-firstn= pairs
	local Translators;															-- assembled translators name list
	t = extract_names (args, 'TranslatorList');									-- fetch translator list from |translatorn= / |translator-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
	
	local Interviewers = A['Interviewers']
	
	local c = {};																-- contributors list from |contributor-lastn= / contributor-firstn= pairs
	local Contributors;															-- assembled contributors name list
	local Contribution = A['Contribution'];
	if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(A['Periodical']) then	-- |contributor= and |contribution= only supported in book cites
		c = extract_names (args, 'ContributorList');							-- fetch contributor list from |contributorn= / |contributor-lastn=, -firstn=, -linkn=, -maskn=
		
		if 0 < #c then
			if not is_set (Contribution) then									-- |contributor= requires |contribution=
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'contribution')});	-- add missing contribution error message
				c = {};															-- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
			end
			if 0 == #a then														-- |contributor= requires |author=
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_missing_required_param', 'author')});	-- add missing author error message
				c = {};															-- blank the contributors' table; it is used as a flag later
			end
		end
	else																		-- if not a book cite
		if select_one (args, cfg.aliases['ContributorList-Last'], 'redundant_parameters', 1 ) then	-- are there contributor name list parameters?
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'contributor_ignored')});	-- add contributor ignored error message
		end
		Contribution = nil;														-- unset
	end

	if not is_valid_parameter_value (NameListFormat, 'name-list-format', cfg.keywords['name-list-format']) then			-- only accepted value for this parameter is 'vanc'
		NameListFormat = '';													-- anything else, set to empty string
	end

	local Year = A['Year'];
	local PublicationDate = A['PublicationDate'];
	local OrigYear = A['OrigYear'];
	local Date = A['Date'];
	local LayDate = A['LayDate'];
	------------------------------------------------- Get title data
	local Title = A['Title'];
	local ScriptTitle = A['ScriptTitle'];
	local BookTitle = A['BookTitle'];
	local Conference = A['Conference'];
	local TransTitle = A['TransTitle'];
	local TitleNote = A['TitleNote'];
	local TitleLink = A['TitleLink'];
			link_title_ok (TitleLink, A:ORIGIN ('TitleLink'), Title, 'title');	-- check for wikimarkup in |title-link= or wikimarkup in |title= when |title-link= is set

	local Chapter = A['Chapter'];
	local ScriptChapter = A['ScriptChapter'];
	local ChapterLink	-- = A['ChapterLink'];									-- deprecated as a parameter but still used internally by cite episode
	local TransChapter = A['TransChapter'];
	local TitleType = A['TitleType'];
	local Degree = A['Degree'];
	local Docket = A['Docket'];
	local ArchiveFormat = A['ArchiveFormat'];

	local ArchiveDate;
	local ArchiveURL;

	ArchiveURL, ArchiveDate = archive_url_check (A['ArchiveURL'], A['ArchiveDate'])
	
	local DeadURL = A['DeadURL']
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (DeadURL, 'dead-url', cfg.keywords ['deadurl']) then	-- set in config.defaults to 'yes'
			DeadURL = '';														-- anything else, set to empty string
		end

	local URL = A['URL']
	local URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL');											-- get name of parameter that holds URL
	local ChapterURL = A['ChapterURL'];
	local ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ChapterURL');							-- get name of parameter that holds ChapterURL
	local ConferenceFormat = A['ConferenceFormat'];
	local ConferenceURL = A['ConferenceURL'];
	local ConferenceURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ConferenceURL');						-- get name of parameter that holds ConferenceURL
	local Periodical = A['Periodical'];
	local Periodical_origin = A:ORIGIN('Periodical');							-- get the name of the periodical parameter

	local Series = A['Series'];
	
	local Volume;
	local Issue;
	local Page;
	local Pages;
	local At;
																				-- previously conference books did not support volume
--	if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) and not ('conference' == config.CitationClass and not is_set (Periodical)) then
	if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_volume) then
		Volume = A['Volume'];
	end
																				-- conference & map books do not support issue
	if in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_using_issue) and not (in_array (config.CitationClass, {'conference', 'map'}) and not is_set (Periodical))then
		Issue = A['Issue'];
	end
	local Position = '';
	if not in_array (config.CitationClass, cfg.templates_not_using_page) then
		Page = A['Page'];
		Pages = hyphen_to_dash( A['Pages'] );	
		At = A['At'];
	end

	local Edition = A['Edition'];
	local PublicationPlace = A['PublicationPlace']
	local Place = A['Place'];
	
	local PublisherName = A['PublisherName'];
	local RegistrationRequired = A['RegistrationRequired'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (RegistrationRequired, 'registration', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
			RegistrationRequired=nil;
		end
	local SubscriptionRequired = A['SubscriptionRequired'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (SubscriptionRequired, 'subscription', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
			SubscriptionRequired=nil;
		end
	local UrlAccess = A['UrlAccess'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (UrlAccess, 'url-access', cfg.keywords ['url-access']) then
			UrlAccess = nil;
		end
		if not is_set(URL) and is_set(UrlAccess) then
			UrlAccess = nil;
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'param_access_requires_param', {'url'}, true ) } );
		end

		if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then			-- while not aliases, these are much the same so if both are set
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'subscription')}, true ) } );		-- add error message
			SubscriptionRequired = nil;											-- unset; prefer |access= over |subscription=
		end
		if is_set (UrlAccess) and is_set (RegistrationRequired) then			-- these are not the same but contradictory so if both are set
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'url-access') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'registration')}, true ) } );		-- add error message
			RegistrationRequired = nil;											-- unset; prefer |access= over |registration=
		end


	local Via = A['Via'];
	local AccessDate = A['AccessDate'];
	local Agency = A['Agency'];

	local Language = A['Language'];
	local Format = A['Format'];
	local ChapterFormat = A['ChapterFormat'];
	local DoiBroken = A['DoiBroken'];
	local ID = A['ID'];
	local ASINTLD = A['ASINTLD'];
	local IgnoreISBN = A['IgnoreISBN'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (IgnoreISBN, 'ignore-isbn-error', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
			IgnoreISBN = nil;													-- anything else, set to empty string
		end
	local Embargo = A['Embargo'];
	local Class = A['Class'];													-- arxiv class identifier

	local ID_list = extract_ids( args );
	local ID_access_levels = extract_id_access_levels( args, ID_list );

	local Quote = A['Quote'];

	local LayFormat = A['LayFormat'];
	local LayURL = A['LayURL'];
	local LaySource = A['LaySource'];
	local Transcript = A['Transcript'];
	local TranscriptFormat = A['TranscriptFormat'];
	local TranscriptURL = A['TranscriptURL'] 
	local TranscriptURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('TranscriptURL');						-- get name of parameter that holds TranscriptURL

	local LastAuthorAmp = A['LastAuthorAmp'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (LastAuthorAmp, 'last-author-amp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
			LastAuthorAmp = nil;												-- set to empty string
		end
		if 'mla' == Mode then												
			LastAuthorAmp = 'yes';												-- replaces last author/editor separator with ' and ' text
		end
	local no_tracking_cats = A['NoTracking'];
		if not is_valid_parameter_value (no_tracking_cats, 'no-tracking', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
			no_tracking_cats = nil;												-- set to empty string
		end

--these deprecated parameters are used by cite interview
	local Callsign = A['Callsign'];
	local City = A['City'];
	local Program = A['Program'];

--local variables that are not cs1 parameters
	local use_lowercase;														-- controls capitalization of certain static text
	local this_page = mw.title.getCurrentTitle();								-- also used for COinS and for language
	local anchor_year;															-- used in the CITEREF identifier
	local COinS_date = {};														-- holds date info extracted from |date= for the COinS metadata by Module:Date verification

	local DF = A['DF'];															-- date format set in cs1|2 template
	if not is_valid_parameter_value (DF, 'df', cfg.keywords['date-format']) then	-- validate reformatting keyword
		DF = '';																-- not valid, set to empty string
	end

	local sepc;											-- separator between citation elements for CS1 a period, for CS2, a comma
	local PostScript;
	local Ref;
	sepc, PostScript, Ref = set_style (Mode:lower(), A['PostScript'], A['Ref'], config.CitationClass);
	use_lowercase = ( sepc == ',' );					-- used to control capitalization for certain static text

--check this page to see if it is in one of the namespaces that cs1 is not supposed to add to the error categories
	if not is_set (no_tracking_cats) then										-- ignore if we are already not going to categorize this page
		if in_array (this_page.nsText, cfg.uncategorized_namespaces) then
			no_tracking_cats = "true";											-- set no_tracking_cats
		end
		for _,v in ipairs (cfg.uncategorized_subpages) do						-- cycle through page name patterns
			if this_page.text:match (v) then									-- test page name against each pattern
				no_tracking_cats = "true";										-- set no_tracking_cats
				break;															-- bail out if one is found
			end
		end
	end

-- check for extra |page=, |pages= or |at= parameters. (also sheet and sheets while we're at it)
	select_one( args, {'page', 'p', 'pp', 'pages', 'at', 'sheet', 'sheets'}, 'redundant_parameters' );		-- this is a dummy call simply to get the error message and category

	local NoPP = A['NoPP'] 
	if is_set (NoPP) and is_valid_parameter_value (NoPP, 'nopp', cfg.keywords ['yes_true_y']) then
		NoPP = true;
	else
		NoPP = nil;																-- unset, used as a flag later
	end

	if is_set(Page) then
		if is_set(Pages) or is_set(At) then
			Pages = '';															-- unset the others
			At = '';
		end
		extra_text_in_page_check (Page);										-- add this page to maint cat if |page= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
	elseif is_set(Pages) then
		if is_set(At) then
			At = '';															-- unset
		end
		extra_text_in_page_check (Pages);										-- add this page to maint cat if |pages= value begins with what looks like p. or pp.
	end	

-- both |publication-place= and |place= (|location=) allowed if different
	if not is_set(PublicationPlace) and is_set(Place) then
		PublicationPlace = Place;							-- promote |place= (|location=) to |publication-place
	end
	
	if PublicationPlace == Place then Place = ''; end		-- don't need both if they are the same
	
--[[
Parameter remapping for cite encyclopedia:
When the citation has these parameters:
	|encyclopedia and |title then map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
	|encyclopedia and |article then map |encyclopedia to |title
	|encyclopedia then map |encyclopedia to |title

	|trans_title maps to |trans_chapter when |title is re-mapped
	|url maps to |chapterurl when |title is remapped

All other combinations of |encyclopedia, |title, and |article are not modified

]]

local Encyclopedia = A['Encyclopedia'];

	if ( config.CitationClass == "encyclopaedia" ) or ( config.CitationClass == "citation" and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then	-- test code for citation
		if is_set(Periodical) then												-- Periodical is set when |encyclopedia is set
			if is_set(Title) or is_set (ScriptTitle) then
				if not is_set(Chapter) then
					Chapter = Title;											-- |encyclopedia and |title are set so map |title to |article and |encyclopedia to |title
					ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
					TransChapter = TransTitle;
					ChapterURL = URL;
					if not is_set (ChapterURL) and is_set (TitleLink) then
						Chapter= '[[' .. TitleLink .. '|' .. Chapter .. ']]';
					end
					Title = Periodical;
					ChapterFormat = Format;
					Periodical = '';											-- redundant so unset
					TransTitle = '';
					URL = '';
					Format = '';
					TitleLink = '';
					ScriptTitle = '';
				end
			else																-- |title not set
				Title = Periodical;												-- |encyclopedia set and |article set or not set so map |encyclopedia to |title
				Periodical = '';												-- redundant so unset
			end
		end
	end

-- Special case for cite techreport.
	if (config.CitationClass == "techreport") then								-- special case for cite techreport
		if is_set(A['Number']) then												-- cite techreport uses 'number', which other citations alias to 'issue'
			if not is_set(ID) then												-- can we use ID for the "number"?
				ID = A['Number'];												-- yes, use it
			else																-- ID has a value so emit error message
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error('redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'id') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'number')}, true )});
			end
		end	
	end

-- special case for cite interview
-- TODO: make cite interview not need any special cases
--[[
Program, Callsign, City deprecated, so avoid using /Configuration
for reassignment, which would allow these parameters' use outside interview
]]
	if (config.CitationClass == "interview") then
		if is_set(Program) then
			if not is_set(Periodical) then
				Periodical = Program;
			end
		end
		if is_set(Callsign) then
			if not is_set(PublisherName) then
				PublisherName = Callsign;
			end
		end
		if is_set(City) then
			if not is_set(PublicationPlace) then
				PublicationPlace = City;
			end
		end
	end

-- special case for cite mailing list
	if (config.CitationClass == "mailinglist") then
		Periodical = A ['MailingList'];
	elseif 'mailinglist' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then
		Periodical = '';														-- unset because mailing list is only used for cite mailing list
	end

-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite conference}}, before generation of COinS data.
	if 'conference' == config.CitationClass then
		if is_set(BookTitle) then
			Chapter = Title;
--			ChapterLink = TitleLink;											-- |chapterlink= is deprecated
			ChapterURL = URL;
			ChapterURLorigin = URLorigin;
			URLorigin = '';
			ChapterFormat = Format;
			TransChapter = TransTitle;
			Title = BookTitle;
			Format = '';
--			TitleLink = '';
			TransTitle = '';
			URL = '';
		end
	elseif 'speech' ~= config.CitationClass then
		Conference = '';														-- not cite conference or cite speech so make sure this is empty string
	end

-- cite map oddities
	local Cartography = "";
	local Scale = "";
	local Sheet = A['Sheet'] or '';
	local Sheets = A['Sheets'] or '';
	if config.CitationClass == "map" then
		Chapter = A['Map'];
		ChapterURL = A['MapURL'];
		TransChapter = A['TransMap'];
		ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('MapURL');
		ChapterFormat = A['MapFormat'];
		
		Cartography = A['Cartography'];
		if is_set( Cartography ) then
			Cartography = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('cartography', Cartography, use_lowercase);
		end		
		Scale = A['Scale'];
		if is_set( Scale ) then
			Scale = sepc .. " " .. Scale;
		end
	end

-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite episode}} and {{cite serial}}, before generation of COinS data.
	if 'episode' == config.CitationClass or 'serial' == config.CitationClass then
		local AirDate = A['AirDate'];
		local SeriesLink = A['SeriesLink'];

		link_title_ok (SeriesLink, A:ORIGIN ('SeriesLink'), Series, 'series');	-- check for wikimarkup in |series-link= or wikimarkup in |series= when |series-link= is set

		local Network = A['Network'];
		local Station = A['Station'];
		local s, n = {}, {};
																				-- do common parameters first
		if is_set(Network) then table.insert(n, Network); end
		if is_set(Station) then table.insert(n, Station); end
		ID = table.concat(n, sepc .. ' ');
		
		if not is_set (Date) and is_set (AirDate) then							-- promote airdate to date
			Date = AirDate;
		end

		if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then								-- handle the oddities that are strictly {{cite episode}}
			local Season = A['Season'];
			local SeriesNumber = A['SeriesNumber'];

			if is_set (Season) and is_set (SeriesNumber) then					-- these are mutually exclusive so if both are set
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'season') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'seriesno')}, true ) } );		-- add error message
				SeriesNumber = '';												-- unset; prefer |season= over |seriesno=
			end
																				-- assemble a table of parts concatenated later into Series
			if is_set(Season) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('season', Season, use_lowercase)); end
			if is_set(SeriesNumber) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('series', SeriesNumber, use_lowercase)); end
			if is_set(Issue) then table.insert(s, wrap_msg ('episode', Issue, use_lowercase)); end
			Issue = '';															-- unset because this is not a unique parameter
	
			Chapter = Title;													-- promote title parameters to chapter
			ScriptChapter = ScriptTitle;
			ChapterLink = TitleLink;											-- alias episodelink
			TransChapter = TransTitle;
			ChapterURL = URL;
			ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('URL');
			
			Title = Series;														-- promote series to title
			TitleLink = SeriesLink;
			Series = table.concat(s, sepc .. ' ');								-- this is concatenation of season, seriesno, episode number

			if is_set (ChapterLink) and not is_set (ChapterURL) then			-- link but not URL
				Chapter = '[[' .. ChapterLink .. '|' .. Chapter .. ']]';		-- ok to wikilink
			elseif is_set (ChapterLink) and is_set (ChapterURL) then			-- if both are set, URL links episode;
				Series = '[[' .. ChapterLink .. '|' .. Series .. ']]';			-- series links with ChapterLink (episodelink -> TitleLink -> ChapterLink) ugly
			end
			URL = '';															-- unset
			TransTitle = '';
			ScriptTitle = '';
			
		else																	-- now oddities that are cite serial
			Issue = '';															-- unset because this parameter no longer supported by the citation/core version of cite serial
			Chapter = A['Episode'];												-- TODO: make |episode= available to cite episode someday?
			if is_set (Series) and is_set (SeriesLink) then
				Series = '[[' .. SeriesLink .. '|' .. Series .. ']]';
			end
			Series = wrap_style ('italic-title', Series);						-- series is italicized
		end	
	end
-- end of {{cite episode}} stuff

-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, before generation of COinS data.
	if 'arxiv' == config.CitationClass then
		if not is_set (ID_list['ARXIV']) then									-- |arxiv= or |eprint= required for cite arxiv
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'arxiv_missing', {}, true ) } );		-- add error message
		elseif is_set (Series) then												-- series is an alias of version
			ID_list['ARXIV'] = ID_list['ARXIV'] .. Series;						-- concatenate version onto the end of the arxiv identifier
			Series = '';														-- unset
			deprecated_parameter ('version');									-- deprecated parameter but only for cite arxiv
		end
		
		if first_set ({AccessDate, At, Authors, Chapter, Format, Page, Pages, Periodical, PublisherName, URL,	-- a crude list of parameters that are not supported by cite arxiv
			ID_list['ASIN'], ID_list['BIBCODE'], ID_list['DOI'], ID_list['ISBN'], ID_list['ISSN'],		-- TODO: find a better way to do this
			ID_list['JFM'], ID_list['JSTOR'], ID_list['LCCN'], ID_list['MR'], ID_list['OCLC'], ID_list['OL'],
			ID_list['OSTI'], ID_list['PMC'], ID_list['PMID'], ID_list['RFC'], ID_list['SSRN'], ID_list['USENETID'], ID_list['ZBL']},27) then
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'arxiv_params_not_supported', {}, true ) } );		-- add error message

				AccessDate = '';												-- set these to empty string; not supported in cite arXiv
				Authors = '';
				PublisherName = '';												-- (if the article has been published, use cite journal, or other)
				Chapter = '';
				URL = '';
				Format = '';
				Page = ''; Pages = ''; At = '';
		end
		Periodical = 'arXiv';													-- set to arXiv for COinS; after that, must be set to empty string
	end

-- handle type parameter for those CS1 citations that have default values
	if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"AV-media-notes", "interview", "mailinglist", "map", "podcast", "pressrelease", "report", "techreport", "thesis"}) then
		TitleType = set_titletype (config.CitationClass, TitleType);
		if is_set(Degree) and "Thesis" == TitleType then						-- special case for cite thesis
			TitleType = Degree .. ' ' .. cfg.title_types ['thesis']:lower();
		end
	end

	if is_set(TitleType) then													-- if type parameter is specified
		TitleType = substitute( cfg.messages['type'], TitleType);				-- display it in parentheses
	-- TODO: Hack on TitleType to fix bunched parentheses problem
	end

-- legacy: promote PublicationDate to Date if neither Date nor Year are set.
	if not is_set (Date) then
		Date = Year;															-- promote Year to Date
		Year = nil;																-- make nil so Year as empty string isn't used for CITEREF
		if not is_set (Date) and is_set(PublicationDate) then					-- use PublicationDate when |date= and |year= are not set
			Date = PublicationDate;												-- promote PublicationDate to Date
			PublicationDate = '';												-- unset, no longer needed
		end
	end

	if PublicationDate == Date then PublicationDate = ''; end					-- if PublicationDate is same as Date, don't display in rendered citation

--[[
Go test all of the date-holding parameters for valid MOS:DATE format and make sure that dates are real dates. This must be done before we do COinS because here is where
we get the date used in the metadata.

Date validation supporting code is in Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation
]]
	do	-- create defined block to contain local variables error_message, date_parameters_list, mismatch
		local error_message = '';
																				-- AirDate has been promoted to Date so not necessary to check it
		local date_parameters_list = {['access-date']=AccessDate, ['archive-date']=ArchiveDate, ['date']=Date, ['doi-broken-date']=DoiBroken,
				['embargo']=Embargo, ['lay-date']=LayDate, ['publication-date']=PublicationDate, ['year']=Year};

		anchor_year, Embargo, error_message = dates(date_parameters_list, COinS_date);

		if is_set (Year) and is_set (Date) then									-- both |date= and |year= not normally needed; 
			local mismatch = year_date_check (Year, Date)
			if 0 == mismatch then												-- |year= does not match a year-value in |date=
				if is_set (error_message) then									-- if there is already an error message
					error_message = error_message .. ', ';						-- tack on this additional message
				end
				error_message = error_message .. '&#124;year= / &#124;date= mismatch';
			elseif 1 == mismatch then											-- |year= matches year-value in |date=
				add_maint_cat ('date_year');
			end
		end
		
		if not is_set(error_message) then										-- error free dates only
			local modified = false;												-- flag
			if is_set (DF) then													-- if we need to reformat dates
				modified = reformat_dates (date_parameters_list, DF, false);	-- reformat to DF format, use long month names if appropriate
			end

			if true == date_hyphen_to_dash (date_parameters_list) then					-- convert hyphens to dashes where appropriate
				modified = true;
				add_maint_cat ('date_format');									-- hyphens were converted so add maint category
			end
			
			if modified then													-- if the date_parameters_list values were modified
				AccessDate = date_parameters_list['access-date'];				-- overwrite date holding parameters with modified values
				ArchiveDate = date_parameters_list['archive-date'];
				Date = date_parameters_list['date'];
				DoiBroken = date_parameters_list['doi-broken-date'];
				LayDate = date_parameters_list['lay-date'];
				PublicationDate = date_parameters_list['publication-date'];
			end
		else
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'bad_date', {error_message}, true ) } );	-- add this error message
		end
	end	-- end of do

-- Account for the oddity that is {{cite journal}} with |pmc= set and |url= not set.  Do this after date check but before COInS.
-- Here we unset Embargo if PMC not embargoed (|embargo= not set in the citation) or if the embargo time has expired. Otherwise, holds embargo date
	Embargo = is_embargoed (Embargo);											-- 

	if config.CitationClass == "journal" and not is_set(URL) and is_set(ID_list['PMC']) then
		if not is_set (Embargo) then											-- if not embargoed or embargo has expired
			URL=cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].prefix .. ID_list['PMC'];				-- set url to be the same as the PMC external link if not embargoed
			URLorigin = cfg.id_handlers['PMC'].parameters[1];					-- set URLorigin to parameter name for use in error message if citation is missing a |title=
			if is_set(AccessDate) then											-- access date requires |url=; pmc created url is not |url=
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
				AccessDate = '';												-- unset
			end

		end
	end

-- At this point fields may be nil if they weren't specified in the template use.  We can use that fact.
	-- Test if citation has no title
	if	not is_set(Title) and
		not is_set(TransTitle) and
		not is_set(ScriptTitle) then
			if 'episode' == config.CitationClass then							-- special case for cite episode; TODO: is there a better way to do this?
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'series'}, true ) } );
			else
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'citation_missing_title', {'title'}, true ) } );
			end
	end
	
	if 'none' == Title and in_array (config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'citation'}) and is_set (Periodical) and 'journal' == A:ORIGIN('Periodical') then	-- special case for journal cites
		Title = '';																-- set title to empty string
		add_maint_cat ('untitled');
	end

	check_for_url ({															-- add error message when any of these parameters contains a URL
		['title']=Title,
		[A:ORIGIN('Chapter')]=Chapter,
		[A:ORIGIN('Periodical')]=Periodical,
		[A:ORIGIN('PublisherName')] = PublisherName
		});

	-- COinS metadata (see <http://ocoins.info/>) for automated parsing of citation information.
	-- handle the oddity that is cite encyclopedia and {{citation |encyclopedia=something}}. Here we presume that
	-- when Periodical, Title, and Chapter are all set, then Periodical is the book (encyclopedia) title, Title
	-- is the article title, and Chapter is a section within the article.  So, we remap 
	
	local coins_chapter = Chapter;												-- default assuming that remapping not required
	local coins_title = Title;													-- et tu
	if 'encyclopaedia' == config.CitationClass or ('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
		if is_set (Chapter) and is_set (Title) and is_set (Periodical) then		-- if all are used then
			coins_chapter = Title;												-- remap
			coins_title = Periodical;
		end
	end
	local coins_author = a;														-- default for coins rft.au 
	if 0 < #c then																-- but if contributor list
		coins_author = c;														-- use that instead
	end

	-- this is the function call to COinS()
	local OCinSoutput = COinS({
		['Periodical'] = Periodical,
		['Encyclopedia'] = Encyclopedia,
		['Chapter'] = make_coins_title (coins_chapter, ScriptChapter),			-- Chapter and ScriptChapter stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
		['Degree'] = Degree;													-- cite thesis only
		['Title'] = make_coins_title (coins_title, ScriptTitle),				-- Title and ScriptTitle stripped of bold / italic wikimarkup
		['PublicationPlace'] = PublicationPlace,
		['Date'] = COinS_date.rftdate,											-- COinS_date has correctly formatted date if Date is valid;
		['Season'] = COinS_date.rftssn,
		['Chron'] =  COinS_date.rftchron or (not COinS_date.rftdate and Date) or '',	-- chron but if not set and invalid date format use Date; keep this last bit?
		['Series'] = Series,
		['Volume'] = Volume,
		['Issue'] = Issue,
		['Pages'] = get_coins_pages (first_set ({Sheet, Sheets, Page, Pages, At}, 5)),				-- pages stripped of external links
		['Edition'] = Edition,
		['PublisherName'] = PublisherName,
		['URL'] = first_set ({ChapterURL, URL}, 2),
		['Authors'] = coins_author,
		['ID_list'] = ID_list,
		['RawPage'] = this_page.prefixedText,
	}, config.CitationClass);

-- Account for the oddities that are {{cite arxiv}}, AFTER generation of COinS data.
	if 'arxiv' == config.CitationClass then										-- we have set rft.jtitle in COinS to arXiv, now unset so it isn't displayed
		Periodical = '';														-- periodical not allowed in cite arxiv; if article has been published, use cite journal
	end

-- special case for cite newsgroup.  Do this after COinS because we are modifying Publishername to include some static text
	if 'newsgroup' == config.CitationClass then
		if is_set (PublisherName) then
			PublisherName = substitute (cfg.messages['newsgroup'], external_link( 'news:' .. PublisherName, PublisherName, A:ORIGIN('PublisherName'), nil ));
		end
	end



	-- Now perform various field substitutions.
	-- We also add leading spaces and surrounding markup and punctuation to the
	-- various parts of the citation, but only when they are non-nil.
	local EditorCount;															-- used only for choosing {ed.) or (eds.) annotation at end of editor name-list
	do
		local last_first_list;
		local control = { 
			format = NameListFormat,											-- empty string or 'vanc'
			maximum = nil,														-- as if display-authors or display-editors not set
			lastauthoramp = LastAuthorAmp,
			page_name = this_page.text,											-- get current page name so that we don't wikilink to it via editorlinkn
			mode = Mode
		};

		do																		-- do editor name list first because coauthors can modify control table
			control.maximum , editor_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayEditors'], #e, 'editors', editor_etal);
			last_first_list, EditorCount = list_people(control, e, editor_etal);

			if is_set (Editors) then
				if editor_etal then
					Editors = Editors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al'];			-- add et al. to editors parameter beause |display-editors=etal
					EditorCount = 2;											-- with et al., |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
				else
					EditorCount = 2;											-- we don't know but assume |editors= is multiple names; spoof to display (eds.) annotation
				end
			else
				Editors = last_first_list;										-- either an author name list or an empty string
			end

			if 1 == EditorCount and (true == editor_etal or 1 < #e) then		-- only one editor displayed but includes etal then 
				EditorCount = 2;												-- spoof to display (eds.) annotation
			end
		end
		do																		-- now do translators
			control.maximum = #t;												-- number of translators
			Translators = list_people(control, t, false);						-- et al not currently supported
		end
		do																		-- now do contributors
			control.maximum = #c;												-- number of contributors
			Contributors = list_people(control, c, false);						-- et al not currently supported
		end
		do																		-- now do authors
			control.maximum , author_etal = get_display_authors_editors (A['DisplayAuthors'], #a, 'authors', author_etal);

			if is_set(Coauthors) then											-- if the coauthor field is also used, prevent ampersand and et al. formatting.
				control.lastauthoramp = nil;
				control.maximum = #a + 1;
			end
			
			last_first_list = list_people(control, a, author_etal);

			if is_set (Authors) then
				Authors, author_etal = name_has_etal (Authors, author_etal, false);	-- find and remove variations on et al.
				if author_etal then
					Authors = Authors .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['et al'];			-- add et al. to authors parameter
				end
			else
				Authors = last_first_list;										-- either an author name list or an empty string
			end
		end																		-- end of do
	
		if is_set (Authors) and is_set (Collaboration) then
			Authors = Authors .. ' (' .. Collaboration .. ')';					-- add collaboration after et al.
		end

		if not is_set(Authors) and is_set(Coauthors) then						-- coauthors aren't displayed if one of authors=, authorn=, or lastn= isn't specified
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error('coauthors_missing_author', {}, true) } );	-- emit error message
		end
	end

-- apply |[xx-]format= styling; at the end, these parameters hold correctly styled format annotation,
-- an error message if the associated url is not set, or an empty string for concatenation
	ArchiveFormat = style_format (ArchiveFormat, ArchiveURL, 'archive-format', 'archive-url');
	ConferenceFormat = style_format (ConferenceFormat, ConferenceURL, 'conference-format', 'conference-url');
	Format = style_format (Format, URL, 'format', 'url');
	LayFormat = style_format (LayFormat, LayURL, 'lay-format', 'lay-url');
	TranscriptFormat = style_format (TranscriptFormat, TranscriptURL, 'transcript-format', 'transcripturl');

-- special case for chapter format so no error message or cat when chapter not supported
	if not (in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv'}) or
		('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia))) then
			ChapterFormat = style_format (ChapterFormat, ChapterURL, 'chapter-format', 'chapter-url');
	end

	if not is_set(URL) then
		if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"web","podcast", "mailinglist"}) then	-- |url= required for cite web, cite podcast, and cite mailinglist
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'cite_web_url', {}, true ) } );
		end
		
		-- do we have |accessdate= without either |url= or |chapter-url=?
		if is_set(AccessDate) and not is_set(ChapterURL)then					-- ChapterURL may be set when URL is not set;
			table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'accessdate_missing_url', {}, true ) } );
			AccessDate = '';
		end
	end

	local OriginalURL, OriginalURLorigin, OriginalFormat, OriginalAccess;
	DeadURL = DeadURL:lower();													-- used later when assembling archived text
	if is_set( ArchiveURL ) then
		if is_set (ChapterURL) then 											-- URL not set so if chapter-url is set apply archive url to it
			OriginalURL = ChapterURL;											-- save copy of source chapter's url for archive text
			OriginalURLorigin = ChapterURLorigin;								-- name of chapter-url parameter for error messages
			OriginalFormat = ChapterFormat;										-- and original |format=
			if 'no' ~= DeadURL then
				ChapterURL = ArchiveURL											-- swap-in the archive's url
				ChapterURLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL')						-- name of archive-url parameter for error messages
				ChapterFormat = ArchiveFormat or '';							-- swap in archive's format
			end
		elseif is_set (URL) then
			OriginalURL = URL;													-- save copy of original source URL
			OriginalURLorigin = URLorigin;										-- name of url parameter for error messages
			OriginalFormat = Format; 											-- and original |format=
			OriginalAccess = UrlAccess;
			if 'no' ~= DeadURL then												-- if URL set then archive-url applies to it
				URL = ArchiveURL												-- swap-in the archive's url
				URLorigin = A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL')								-- name of archive url parameter for error messages
				Format = ArchiveFormat or '';									-- swap in archive's format
				UrlAccess = nil;												-- restricted access levels do not make sense for archived urls
			end
 		end
	end

	if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'arxiv'}) or	-- if any of the 'periodical' cites except encyclopedia
		('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) then
			local chap_param;
			if is_set (Chapter) then											-- get a parameter name from one of these chapter related meta-parameters
				chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('Chapter')
			elseif is_set (TransChapter) then
				chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('TransChapter')
			elseif is_set (ChapterURL) then
				chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterURL')
			elseif is_set (ScriptChapter) then
				chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ScriptChapter')
			else is_set (ChapterFormat)
				chap_param = A:ORIGIN ('ChapterFormat')
			end

			if is_set (chap_param) then											-- if we found one
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'chapter_ignored', {chap_param}, true ) } );		-- add error message
				Chapter = '';													-- and set them to empty string to be safe with concatenation
				TransChapter = '';
				ChapterURL = '';
				ScriptChapter = '';
				ChapterFormat = '';
			end
	else																		-- otherwise, format chapter / article title
		local no_quotes = false;												-- default assume that we will be quoting the chapter parameter value
		if is_set (Contribution) and 0 < #c then								-- if this is a contribution with contributor(s)
			if in_array (Contribution:lower(), cfg.keywords.contribution) then	-- and a generic contribution title
				no_quotes = true;												-- then render it unquoted
			end
		end

		Chapter = format_chapter_title (ScriptChapter, Chapter, TransChapter, ChapterURL, ChapterURLorigin, no_quotes);		-- Contribution is also in Chapter
		if is_set (Chapter) then
			Chapter = Chapter .. ChapterFormat ;
			if 'map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (TitleType) then
				Chapter = Chapter .. ' ' .. TitleType;							-- map annotation here; not after title
			end
			Chapter = Chapter.. sepc .. ' ';
		elseif is_set (ChapterFormat) then										-- |chapter= not set but |chapter-format= is so ...
			Chapter = ChapterFormat .. sepc .. ' ';								-- ... ChapterFormat has error message, we want to see it
		end
	end

	-- Format main title.
	if is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(Title) then
		Title = "[[" .. TitleLink .. "|" .. Title .. "]]"
	end

	if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'web','news','journal', 'magazine', 'pressrelease','podcast', 'newsgroup', 'mailinglist', 'arxiv', 'interview'}) or
		('citation' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical) and not is_set (Encyclopedia)) or
		('map' == config.CitationClass and is_set (Periodical)) then			-- special case for cite map when the map is in a periodical treat as an article
			Title = kern_quotes (Title);										-- if necessary, separate title's leading and trailing quote marks from Module provided quote marks
			Title = wrap_style ('quoted-title', Title);
			Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle);					-- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
			TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle );
	elseif 'report' == config.CitationClass then								-- no styling for cite report
		Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle);						-- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
		TransTitle= wrap_style ('trans-quoted-title', TransTitle );				-- for cite report, use this form for trans-title
	else
		Title = wrap_style ('italic-title', Title);
		Title = script_concatenate (Title, ScriptTitle);						-- <bdi> tags, lang atribute, categorization, etc; must be done after title is wrapped
		TransTitle = wrap_style ('trans-italic-title', TransTitle);
	end

	local TransError = "";
	if is_set(TransTitle) then
		if is_set(Title) then
			TransTitle = " " .. TransTitle;
		else
			TransError = " " .. set_error( 'trans_missing_title', {'title'} );
		end
	end
	
	Title = Title .. TransTitle;
	
	if is_set(Title) then
		if not is_set(TitleLink) and is_set(URL) then
			
			Title = external_link( URL, Title, URLorigin, UrlAccess ) .. TransError .. Format;
-- this experiment hidden 2016-04-10; see Help_talk:Citation_Style_1#Recycled_urls
--			local temp_title = external_link( URL, Title, URLorigin ) .. TransError .. Format;	-- do this so we get error message even if url is usurped no archive
--			if in_array (DeadURL, {'unfit no archive', 'usurped no archive'}) then	-- when url links to inappropriate location and there is no archive of original source available
--				local err_msg
--				if temp_title:match ('%[%S+%s+(.+)%](<.+)') then				-- if there is an error message
--					Title, err_msg = temp_title:match ('%[%S+%s+(.+)%](<.+)');	-- strip off external link; TODO: find a better to do this
--					Title = Title .. (err_msg or '');
--				end
--			else
--				Title = temp_title;
--			end

			URL = '';															-- unset these because no longer needed
			Format = "";
		else
			Title = Title .. TransError;
		end
	end

	if is_set(Place) then
		Place = " " .. wrap_msg ('written', Place, use_lowercase) .. sepc .. " ";
	end

	if is_set (Conference) then
		if is_set (ConferenceURL) then
			Conference = external_link( ConferenceURL, Conference, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
		end
		Conference = sepc .. " " .. Conference .. ConferenceFormat;
	elseif is_set(ConferenceURL) then
		Conference = sepc .. " " .. external_link( ConferenceURL, nil, ConferenceURLorigin, nil );
	end

	if not is_set(Position) then
		local Minutes = A['Minutes'];
		local Time = A['Time'];

		if is_set(Minutes) then
			if is_set (Time) then
				table.insert( z.message_tail, { set_error( 'redundant_parameters', {wrap_style ('parameter', 'minutes') .. ' and ' .. wrap_style ('parameter', 'time')}, true ) } );
			end
			Position = " " .. Minutes .. " " .. cfg.messages['minutes'];
		else
			if is_set(Time) then
				local TimeCaption = A['TimeCaption']
				if not is_set(TimeCaption) then
					TimeCaption = cfg.messages['event'];
					if sepc ~= '.' then
						TimeCaption = TimeCaption:lower();
					end
				end
				Position = " " .. TimeCaption .. " " .. Time;
			end
		end
	else
		Position = " " .. Position;
		At = '';
	end

	Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets = format_pages_sheets (Page, Pages, Sheet, Sheets, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, NoPP, use_lowercase, Mode);

	At = is_set(At) and (sepc .. " " .. At) or "";
	Position = is_set(Position) and (sepc .. " " .. Position) or "";
	if config.CitationClass == 'map' then
		local Section = A['Section'];
		local Sections = A['Sections'];
		local Inset = A['Inset'];
		
		if is_set( Inset ) then
			Inset = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('inset', Inset, use_lowercase);
		end			

		if is_set( Sections ) then
			Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('sections', Sections, use_lowercase);
		elseif is_set( Section ) then
			Section = sepc .. " " .. wrap_msg ('section', Section, use_lowercase);
		end
		At = At .. Inset .. Section;		
	end	

	if is_set (Language) then
		Language = language_parameter (Language);								-- format, categories, name from ISO639-1, etc
	else
		Language="";															-- language not specified so make sure this is an empty string;
	--[[ TODO: need to extract the wrap_msg from language_parameter
	so that we can solve parentheses bunching problem with Format/Language/TitleType
	]]
	end

	Others = is_set(Others) and (sepc .. " " .. Others) or "";
	
	if is_set (Translators) then
		if 'mla' == Mode then
			Others = sepc .. ' Trans. ' .. Translators .. Others;
		else
			Others = sepc .. ' ' .. wrap_msg ('translated', Translators, use_lowercase) .. Others;
		end
	end
	if is_set (Interviewers) then
		Others = sepc .. ' ' .. wrap_msg ('interview', Interviewers, use_lowercase) .. Others;
	end
	
	TitleNote = is_set(TitleNote) and (sepc .. " " .. TitleNote) or "";
	if is_set (Edition) then
		if Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]d%.?$') or Edition:match ('%f[%a][Ee]dition$') then
			add_maint_cat ('extra_text', 'edition');
		end
		if 'mla' == Mode then
			Edition = '. ' .. Edition .. ' ed.';
		else
			Edition = " " .. wrap_msg ('edition', Edition);
		end
	else
		Edition = '';
	end

	Series = is_set(Series) and (sepc .. " " .. Series) or "";
	if 'mla' == Mode then														-- not in brackets for mla
		OrigYear = is_set(OrigYear) and (". " .. OrigYear) or "";
	else
		OrigYear = is_set(OrigYear) and (" [" .. OrigYear .. "]") or "";
	end
	Agency = is_set(Agency) and (sepc .. " " .. Agency) or "";

	Volume = format_volume_issue (Volume, Issue, config.CitationClass, Periodical_origin, sepc, use_lowercase, Mode);

	------------------------------------ totally unrelated data
	if is_set(Via) then
		Via = " " .. wrap_msg ('via', Via);
	end

--[[
Subscription implies paywall; Registration does not.  If both are used in a citation, the subscription required link
note is displayed. There are no error messages for this condition.

]]
	if is_set (SubscriptionRequired) then
		SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['subscription'];		-- subscription required message
	elseif is_set (RegistrationRequired) then
		SubscriptionRequired = sepc .. " " .. cfg.messages['registration'];		-- registration required message
	else
		SubscriptionRequired = '';												-- either or both might be set to something other than yes true y
	end

	if is_set(AccessDate) then
		local retrv_text = " " .. cfg.messages['retrieved']

		AccessDate = nowrap_date (AccessDate);									-- wrap in nowrap span if date in appropriate format
		if 'mla' == Mode then													-- retrieved text not used in mla
			AccessDate = ' ' .. AccessDate;
		else
			if (sepc ~= ".") then retrv_text = retrv_text:lower() end			-- if mode is cs2, lower case
			AccessDate = substitute (retrv_text, AccessDate);					-- add retrieved text
		end
		AccessDate = substitute (cfg.presentation['accessdate'], {sepc, AccessDate});	-- allow editors to hide accessdates
	end
	
	if is_set(ID) then ID = sepc .." ".. ID; end
   	if "thesis" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then
		ID = sepc .." Docket ".. Docket .. ID;
	end
   	if "report" == config.CitationClass and is_set(Docket) then					-- for cite report when |docket= is set
		ID = sepc .. ' ' .. Docket;												-- overwrite ID even if |id= is set
	end

	ID_list = build_id_list( ID_list, {IdAccessLevels=ID_access_levels, DoiBroken = DoiBroken, ASINTLD = ASINTLD, IgnoreISBN = IgnoreISBN, Embargo=Embargo, Class = Class} );

	if is_set(URL) then
		URL = " " .. external_link( URL, nil, URLorigin, Access );
	end

	if is_set(Quote) then
		if Quote:sub(1,1) == '"' and Quote:sub(-1,-1) == '"' then				-- if first and last characters of quote are quote marks
			Quote = Quote:sub(2,-2);											-- strip them off
		end
		Quote = sepc .." " .. wrap_style ('quoted-text', Quote ); 				-- wrap in <q>...</q> tags
		PostScript = "";														-- cs1|2 does not supply terminal punctuation when |quote= is set
	end
	
	local Archived
	if is_set(ArchiveURL) then
		if not is_set(ArchiveDate) then
			ArchiveDate = set_error('archive_missing_date');
		end
		if "no" == DeadURL then
			local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived'];
			if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
			Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( cfg.messages['archived-not-dead'],
				{ external_link( ArchiveURL, arch_text, A:ORIGIN('ArchiveURL'), nil ) .. ArchiveFormat, ArchiveDate } );
			if not is_set(OriginalURL) then
				Archived = Archived .. " " .. set_error('archive_missing_url');							   
			end
		elseif is_set(OriginalURL) then											-- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', 'y', 'unfit', 'usurped'
			local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-dead'];
			if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
			if in_array (DeadURL, {'unfit', 'usurped', 'bot: unknown'}) then
				Archived = sepc .. " " .. 'Archived from the original on ' .. ArchiveDate;	-- format already styled
				if 'bot: unknown' == DeadURL then
					add_maint_cat ('bot:_unknown');								-- and add a category if not already added
				else
					add_maint_cat ('unfit');									-- and add a category if not already added
				end
			else																-- DeadURL is empty, 'yes', 'true', or 'y'
				Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text,
					{ external_link( OriginalURL, cfg.messages['original'], OriginalURLorigin, OriginalAccess ) .. OriginalFormat, ArchiveDate } );	-- format already styled
			end	
		else
			local arch_text = cfg.messages['archived-missing'];
			if sepc ~= "." then arch_text = arch_text:lower() end
			Archived = sepc .. " " .. substitute( arch_text, 
				{ set_error('archive_missing_url'), ArchiveDate } );
		end
	elseif is_set (ArchiveFormat) then
		Archived = ArchiveFormat;												-- if set and ArchiveURL not set ArchiveFormat has error message
	else
		Archived = ""
	end
	
	local Lay = '';
	if is_set(LayURL) then
		if is_set(LayDate) then LayDate = " (" .. LayDate .. ")" end
		if is_set(LaySource) then 
			LaySource = " &ndash; ''" .. safe_for_italics(LaySource) .. "''";
		else
			LaySource = "";
		end
		if sepc == '.' then
			Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary'], A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
		else
			Lay = sepc .. " " .. external_link( LayURL, cfg.messages['lay summary']:lower(), A:ORIGIN('LayURL'), nil ) .. LayFormat .. LaySource .. LayDate
		end			
	elseif is_set (LayFormat) then												-- Test if |lay-format= is given without giving a |lay-url=
		Lay = sepc .. LayFormat;												-- if set and LayURL not set, then LayFormat has error message
	end

	if is_set(Transcript) then
		if is_set(TranscriptURL) then
			Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, Transcript, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
		end
		Transcript = sepc .. ' ' .. Transcript .. TranscriptFormat;
	elseif is_set(TranscriptURL) then
		Transcript = external_link( TranscriptURL, nil, TranscriptURLorigin, nil );
	end

	local Publisher;
	if is_set(PublicationDate) then
		PublicationDate = wrap_msg ('published', PublicationDate);
	end
	if is_set(PublisherName) then
		if is_set(PublicationPlace) then
			Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. ": " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;
		else
			Publisher = sepc .. " " .. PublisherName .. PublicationDate;  
		end			
	elseif is_set(PublicationPlace) then 
		Publisher= sepc .. " " .. PublicationPlace .. PublicationDate;
	else 
		Publisher = PublicationDate;
	end
	
	-- Several of the above rely upon detecting this as nil, so do it last.
	if is_set(Periodical) then
		if is_set(Title) or is_set(TitleNote) then 
			Periodical = sepc .. " " .. wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical) 
		else 
			Periodical = wrap_style ('italic-title', Periodical)
		end
	end

--[[
Handle the oddity that is cite speech.  This code overrides whatever may be the value assigned to TitleNote (through |department=) and forces it to be " (Speech)" so that
the annotation directly follows the |title= parameter value in the citation rather than the |event= parameter value (if provided).
]]
	if "speech" == config.CitationClass then				-- cite speech only
		TitleNote = " (Speech)";							-- annotate the citation
		if is_set (Periodical) then							-- if Periodical, perhaps because of an included |website= or |journal= parameter 
			if is_set (Conference) then						-- and if |event= is set
				Conference = Conference .. sepc .. " ";		-- then add appropriate punctuation to the end of the Conference variable before rendering
			end
		end
	end

	-- Piece all bits together at last.  Here, all should be non-nil.
	-- We build things this way because it is more efficient in LUA
	-- not to keep reassigning to the same string variable over and over.

	local tcommon;
	local tcommon2;																-- used for book cite when |contributor= is set
	
	if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
		if is_set(Others) then Others = Others .. sepc .. " " end
		if 'mla' == Mode then
			tcommon = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
		else
			tcommon = safe_join( {Others, Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, 
				Language, Edition, Publisher, Agency, Volume}, sepc );
		end		
	elseif in_array(config.CitationClass, {"book","citation"}) and not is_set(Periodical) then		-- special cases for book cites
		if is_set (Contributors) then											-- when we are citing foreword, preface, introduction, etc
			tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote}, sepc );					-- author and other stuff will come after this and before tcommon2
			if 'mla' == Mode then
				tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
			else
				tcommon2 = safe_join( {Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
			end
		elseif 'mla' == Mode then
			tcommon = safe_join( {TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
		else
			tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
		end

	elseif 'map' == config.CitationClass then									-- special cases for cite map
		if is_set (Chapter) then												-- map in a book; TitleType is part of Chapter
			tcommon = safe_join( {Title, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
		elseif is_set (Periodical) then											-- map in a periodical
			tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Periodical, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher, Volume}, sepc );
		else																	-- a sheet or stand-alone map
			tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleType, Format, Edition, Scale, Series, Language, Cartography, Others, Publisher}, sepc );
		end
		
	elseif 'episode' == config.CitationClass then								-- special case for cite episode
		tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, TitleType, Series, Transcript, Language, Edition, Publisher}, sepc );

	elseif ('news' == config.CitationClass) and ('mla' == Mode) then			-- special case for cite news in MLA mode
		tcommon = safe_join( {Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, Edition, Agency}, sepc );

	elseif ('web' == config.CitationClass) and ('mla' == Mode) then				-- special case for cite web in MLA mode
		tcommon = safe_join( {Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, 
			Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );

	else																		-- all other CS1 templates
		tcommon = safe_join( {Title, TitleNote, Conference, Periodical, Format, TitleType, Series, Language, 
			Volume, Others, Edition, Publisher, Agency}, sepc );
	end
	
	if #ID_list > 0 then
		ID_list = safe_join( { sepc .. " ",  table.concat( ID_list, sepc .. " " ), ID }, sepc );
	else
		ID_list = ID;
	end
	
	local idcommon = safe_join( { ID_list, URL, Archived, AccessDate, Via, SubscriptionRequired, Lay, Quote }, sepc );
	local text;
	local pgtext = Position .. Sheet .. Sheets .. Page .. Pages .. At;

	if is_set(Date) then
		if ('mla' == Mode) then
			if in_array (config.CitationClass, {'book', 'news', 'web'}) then
				Date = ', ' .. Date;											-- origyear follows title in mla
			elseif 'journal' == config.CitationClass then
				Date = ', (' .. Date .. ')';
			end
		elseif is_set (Authors) or is_set (Editors) then						-- date follows authors or editors when authors not set
			Date = " (" .. Date ..")" .. OrigYear .. sepc .. " ";				-- in paranetheses
		else																	-- neither of authors and editors set
			if (string.sub(tcommon,-1,-1) == sepc) then							-- if the last character of tcommon is sepc
				Date = " " .. Date .. OrigYear;									-- Date does not begin with sepc
			else
				Date = sepc .. " " .. Date .. OrigYear;							-- Date begins with sepc
			end
		end
	end	
	if is_set(Authors) then
		if is_set(Coauthors) then
			if 'vanc' == NameListFormat then									-- separate authors and coauthors with proper name-list-separator
				Authors = Authors .. ', ' .. Coauthors;
			else
				Authors = Authors .. '; ' .. Coauthors;
			end
		end
		if (not is_set (Date)) or ('mla' == Mode) then							-- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Authors termination
			Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc);						-- when no date, terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
		end
		if is_set(Editors) then
			local in_text = " ";
			local post_text = "";
			if is_set(Chapter) and 0 == #c and 'mla' ~= Mode then
				in_text = in_text .. cfg.messages['in'] .. " "
				if (sepc ~= '.') then in_text = in_text:lower() end				-- lowercase for cs2
			elseif is_set(Chapter) and 'mla' == Mode then
				if EditorCount <= 1 then
					in_text = '. Ed. ';
				else
					in_text = '. Eds. ';
				end
			else
				if EditorCount <= 1 then
					post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
				else
					post_text = ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
				end
			end 
			Editors = terminate_name_list (in_text .. Editors .. post_text, sepc);	-- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
		end
		if is_set (Contributors) then											-- book cite and we're citing the intro, preface, etc
			local by_text = sepc .. ' ' .. cfg.messages['by'] .. ' ';
			if (sepc ~= '.') then by_text = by_text:lower() end					-- lowercase for cs2
			Authors = by_text .. Authors;										-- author follows title so tweak it here
			if is_set (Editors) and ('mla' ~= Mode)then											-- when Editors make sure that Authors gets terminated
				Authors = terminate_name_list (Authors, sepc);					-- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
			end
			if (not is_set (Date)) or ('mla' == Mode) then											-- when date is set it's in parentheses; no Contributors termination
				Contributors = terminate_name_list (Contributors, sepc);		-- terminate with 0 or 1 sepc and a space
			end
			if 'mla' == Mode then
				text = safe_join( {Contributors, Chapter, tcommon, OrigYear, Authors, Place, Others, Editors, tcommon2, Date, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
			else
				text = safe_join( {Contributors, Date, Chapter, tcommon, Authors, Place, Editors, tcommon2, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
			end
		elseif 'mla' == Mode then
			tcommon = tcommon .. Date;											-- hack to avoid duplicate separators
			text = safe_join( {Authors, Chapter, Title, OrigYear, Others, Editors, Edition, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
		else
			text = safe_join( {Authors, Date, Chapter, Place, Editors, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon }, sepc );
		end
	elseif is_set(Editors) then
		if is_set(Date) then
			if EditorCount <= 1 then
				Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editor'];
			else
				Editors = Editors .. ", " .. cfg.messages['editors'];
			end
		else
			if EditorCount <= 1 then
				Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editor'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
			else
				Editors = Editors .. " (" .. cfg.messages['editors'] .. ")" .. sepc .. " "
			end
		end
		if 'mla' == Mode then
			if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'news', 'web'}) and is_set(Periodical) then
				text = safe_join( {Editors, Title, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
			else
				text = safe_join( {Editors, Chapter, Title, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
			end
		else
			text = safe_join( {Editors, Date, Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
		end
	elseif 'mla' == Mode then
		if in_array(config.CitationClass, {'journal', 'news', 'web'}) and is_set(Periodical) then
			text = safe_join( {Title, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
		else
			text = safe_join( {Chapter, Title, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
		end
	else
		if in_array(config.CitationClass, {"journal","citation"}) and is_set(Periodical) then
			text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, pgtext, Date, idcommon}, sepc );
		else
			text = safe_join( {Chapter, Place, tcommon, Date, pgtext, idcommon}, sepc );
		end
	end
	
	if is_set(PostScript) and PostScript ~= sepc then
		text = safe_join( {text, sepc}, sepc );  --Deals with italics, spaces, etc.
		text = text:sub(1,-sepc:len()-1);
	end	
	
	text = safe_join( {text, PostScript}, sepc );

	-- Now enclose the whole thing in a <cite/> element
	local options = {};
	
	if is_set(config.CitationClass) and config.CitationClass ~= "citation" then
		options.class = config.CitationClass;
		options.class = "citation " .. config.CitationClass;					-- class=citation required for blue highlight when used with |ref=
	else
		options.class = "citation";
	end
	
	if is_set(Ref) and Ref:lower() ~= "none" then								-- set reference anchor if appropriate
		local id = Ref
		if ('harv' == Ref ) then
			local namelist = {};												-- holds selected contributor, author, editor name list
			local year = first_set ({Year, anchor_year}, 2);					-- Year first for legacy citations and for YMD dates that require disambiguation

			if #c > 0 then														-- if there is a contributor list
				namelist = c;													-- select it
			elseif #a > 0 then													-- or an author list
				namelist = a;
			elseif #e > 0 then													-- or an editor list
				namelist = e;
			end
			if #namelist > 0 then												-- if there are names in namelist
				id = anchor_id (namelist, year);								-- go make the CITEREF anchor
			else
				id = '';														-- unset
			end
		end
		options.id = id;
	end
	
	if string.len(text:gsub("<span[^>/]*>(.-)</span>", "%1"):gsub("%b<>","")) <= 2 then	-- remove <span> tags and other html-like markup; then get length of what remains
		z.error_categories = {};
		text = set_error('empty_citation');
		z.message_tail = {};
	end
	
	if is_set(options.id) then													-- here we wrap the rendered citation in <cite ...>...</cite> tags
		text = substitute (cfg.presentation['cite-id'], {mw.uri.anchorEncode(options.id), mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text});	-- when |ref= is set
	else
		text = substitute (cfg.presentation['cite'], {mw.text.nowiki(options.class), text});	-- all other cases
	end		

	text = text .. substitute (cfg.presentation['ocins'], {OCinSoutput});		-- append metadata to the citation
	
	if #z.message_tail ~= 0 then
		text = text .. " ";
		for i,v in ipairs( z.message_tail ) do
			if is_set(v[1]) then
				if i == #z.message_tail then
					text = text .. error_comment( v[1], v[2] );
				else
					text = text .. error_comment( v[1] .. "; ", v[2] );
				end
			end
		end
	end

	if #z.maintenance_cats ~= 0 then
		text = text .. '<span class="citation-comment" style="display:none; color:#33aa33">';
		for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do								-- append maintenance categories
			text = text .. ' ' .. v .. ' ([[:Category:' .. v ..'|link]])';
		end
		text = text .. '</span>';	-- maintenance mesages (realy just the names of the categories for now)
	end
	
	no_tracking_cats = no_tracking_cats:lower();
	if in_array(no_tracking_cats, {"", "no", "false", "n"}) then
		for _, v in ipairs( z.error_categories ) do
			text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
		end
		for _, v in ipairs( z.maintenance_cats ) do								-- append maintenance categories
			text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
		end
		for _, v in ipairs( z.properties_cats ) do								-- append maintenance categories
			text = text .. '[[Category:' .. v ..']]';
		end
	end
	
	return text
end

--[[--------------------------< C S 1 . C I T A T I O N >------------------------------------------------------

This is used by templates such as {{cite book}} to create the actual citation text.

]]

function cs1.citation(frame)
	Frame = frame;																-- save a copy incase we need to display an error message in preview mode
	local pframe = frame:getParent()
	local validation, utilities, identifiers, metadata;
	
	if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then			-- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
		cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration/sandbox');		-- load sandbox versions of support modules
		whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist/sandbox');
		utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities/sandbox');
		validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation/sandbox');
		identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers/sandbox');
		metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS/sandbox');
		
	else																		-- otherwise
		cfg = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Configuration');				-- load live versions of support modules
		whitelist = mw.loadData ('Module:Citation/CS1/Whitelist');
		utilities = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities');
		validation = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Date_validation');
		identifiers = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/Identifiers');
		metadata = require ('Module:Citation/CS1/COinS');
	end

	utilities.set_selected_modules (cfg);										-- so that functions in Utilities can see the cfg tables
	identifiers.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities);							-- so that functions in Identifiers can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module
	validation.set_selected_modules (utilities);								-- so that functions in Date validataion can see the selected Utilities module
	metadata.set_selected_modules (cfg, utilities);								-- so that functions in COinS can see the selected cfg tables and selected Utilities module

	dates = validation.dates;													-- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Date validation
	year_date_check = validation.year_date_check;
	reformat_dates = validation.reformat_dates;
	date_hyphen_to_dash = validation.date_hyphen_to_dash;
	
	is_set = utilities.is_set;													-- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
	in_array = utilities.in_array;
	substitute = utilities.substitute;
	error_comment = utilities.error_comment;
	set_error = utilities.set_error;
	select_one = utilities.select_one;
	add_maint_cat = utilities.add_maint_cat;
	wrap_style = utilities.wrap_style;
	safe_for_italics = utilities.safe_for_italics;
	remove_wiki_link = utilities.remove_wiki_link;

	z = utilities.z;															-- table of error and category tables in Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities

	extract_ids = identifiers.extract_ids;										-- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/Utilities
	build_id_list = identifiers.build_id_list;
	is_embargoed = identifiers.is_embargoed;
	extract_id_access_levels = identifiers.extract_id_access_levels;
	
	make_coins_title = metadata.make_coins_title;								-- imported functions from Module:Citation/CS1/COinS
	get_coins_pages = metadata.get_coins_pages;
	COinS = metadata.COinS;

	local args = {};
	local suggestions = {};
	local error_text, error_state;

	local config = {};
	for k, v in pairs( frame.args ) do
		config[k] = v;
		args[k] = v;	   
	end	

	local capture;																-- the single supported capture when matching unknown parameters using patterns
	for k, v in pairs( pframe.args ) do
		if v ~= '' then
			if not validate( k ) then			
				error_text = "";
				if type( k ) ~= 'string' then
					-- Exclude empty numbered parameters
					if v:match("%S+") ~= nil then
						error_text, error_state = set_error( 'text_ignored', {v}, true );
					end
				elseif validate( k:lower() ) then 
					error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, k:lower()}, true );
				else
					if nil == suggestions.suggestions then						-- if this table is nil then we need to load it
						if nil ~= string.find (frame:getTitle(), 'sandbox', 1, true) then			-- did the {{#invoke:}} use sandbox version?
							suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions/sandbox' );	-- use the sandbox version
						else
							suggestions = mw.loadData( 'Module:Citation/CS1/Suggestions' );			-- use the live version
						end
					end
					for pattern, param in pairs (suggestions.patterns) do		-- loop through the patterns to see if we can suggest a proper parameter
						capture = k:match (pattern);							-- the whole match if no caputre in pattern else the capture if a match
						if capture then											-- if the pattern matches 
							param = substitute( param, capture );				-- add the capture to the suggested parameter (typically the enumerator)
							error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, param}, true );	-- set the error message
						end
					end
					if not is_set (error_text) then								-- couldn't match with a pattern, is there an expicit suggestion?
						if suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ] ~= nil then
							error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored_suggest', {k, suggestions.suggestions[ k:lower() ]}, true );
						else
							error_text, error_state = set_error( 'parameter_ignored', {k}, true );
						end
					end
				end				  
				if error_text ~= '' then
					table.insert( z.message_tail, {error_text, error_state} );
				end				
			end
			missing_pipe_check (v);												-- do we think that there is a parameter that is missing a pipe?
			
			args[k] = v;
		elseif args[k] ~= nil or (k == 'postscript') then
			args[k] = v;
		end		
	end	

	for k, v in pairs( args ) do
		if 'string' == type (k) then											-- don't evaluate positional parameters
			has_invisible_chars (k, v);
		end
	end
	return citation0( config, args)
end

return cs1;